Bosch Appliances Home Security System D7412G User Manual

D9412G/D7412G  
Program Entry Guide  
EN Control Panels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Table of Contents  
EN | 3  
2.10.1 Cmd Cntr (Command Center) Assignment.. 46  
2.10.2 Area Text.......................................................... 50  
2.10.3 Custom Function.............................................. 51  
Table of Contents  
1.0  
1.1  
1.2  
1.3  
Introduction.......................................................5  
How to use this Program Entry Guide.............5  
Literature Referenced.........................................5  
2.11  
User Interface................................................... 53  
2.11.1 Commands........................................................ 53  
2.11.2 Command Center Selections.......................... 53  
2.11.3 Authority Level Selections.............................. 59  
Differences Between the D9412G and  
D7412G ...............................................................5  
2.12  
2.13  
Function List..................................................... 67  
Relay Parameters ............................................. 67  
1.4  
1.5  
1.6  
1.7  
New Features.......................................................6  
Product Handlers................................................8  
Programming Options........................................8  
Programming the Control Panel with the  
D5200 Programmer............................................9  
2.13.1 Area Relays....................................................... 68  
2.13.2 Panel-Wide Relays........................................... 71  
3.0  
RADXUSR1/RADXUSR2............................ 73  
Passcode/Token Worksheet............................ 73  
User Groups...................................................... 73  
Passcodes........................................................... 73  
User Group Window....................................... 73  
Authority Level by Area ................................. 73  
User Name........................................................ 73  
Tokens/Cards................................................... 73  
Reporting and Logging.................................... 73  
RADXPNTS..................................................... 77  
Point Index ....................................................... 77  
Point Responses................................................ 81  
Point Assignments............................................ 91  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9 ............. 94  
RADXSKED.................................................... 95  
Windows ........................................................... 95  
Opening and Closing....................................... 95  
User Group Windows.................................... 102  
Skeds................................................................ 104  
Holiday Indexes............................................. 113  
Add/Change/Delete ...................................... 113  
View Holidays................................................ 114  
RADXAUX1.................................................. 115  
Introduction.................................................... 115  
3.1  
2.0  
2.1  
2.2  
2.3  
2.3.1  
2.3.2  
9000MAIN........................................................11  
Phone .................................................................11  
Phone Parameters.............................................12  
Routing ..............................................................15  
Called Party Disconnect ..................................15  
Route Number Groups: Which Has the  
Highest Priority?...............................................15  
Programming a Primary and Backup  
Destination ........................................................16  
Enhanced Routing............................................16  
Programming a Duplicate Report...................16  
Routing Destination Communication  
Failures...............................................................16  
Message Prioritization within a Route  
Number..............................................................16  
Dialing Attempts...............................................16  
Enhanced Routing............................................23  
Programming a Primary and Backup  
Destination ........................................................23  
Programming a Duplicate Report...................24  
Power Supervision............................................27  
Printer Parameters............................................29  
RAM Parameters..............................................31  
Uploading and Downloading Reports ...........31  
Log Threshold Reports....................................31  
RAM Callback Reports ...................................31  
Miscellaneous....................................................34  
Area Parameters................................................34  
Area Parameters................................................34  
Programming Account Numbers in 9000  
Series Control Panels, versions 6.20 and  
Higher................................................................35  
Shared-Area Characteristics ............................40  
Bell Parameters .................................................40  
Open/Close Options........................................42  
Command Center.............................................46  
3.1.1  
3.1.2  
3.1.3  
3.1.4  
3.1.5  
3.1.6  
3.1.7  
4.0  
4.1  
4.1.1  
4.2  
4.3  
5.0  
2.3.3  
2.3.4  
2.3.5  
2.3.6  
2.3.7  
5.1  
2.3.8  
2.4  
2.4.1  
5.1.1  
5.1.2  
5.2  
5.3  
2.4.2  
2.5  
2.6  
5.3.1  
5.3.2  
6.0  
6.1  
6.2  
2.7  
2.7.1  
2.7.2  
2.7.3  
2.8  
2.9  
2.9.1  
2.9.2  
RAM IV and D5200 Handler  
Requirements.................................................. 115  
SDI Automation............................................. 115  
SDI RAM Parameters.................................... 116  
User Interface Modifications for  
COMMAND 43............................................. 117  
Using an External Modem............................ 118  
Enhanced Communications.......................... 122  
Programming Path Numbers and  
IP Addresses ................................................... 123  
6.3  
6.4  
6.4.1  
6.4.2  
6.5  
6.5.1  
2.9.3  
2.9.4  
2.9.5  
2.10  
6.6  
SDI RAM/Enhanced Communications  
Configuration.................................................. 125  
Route Group Attempts.................................. 126  
6.6.1  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Table of Contents  
EN | 4  
6.7  
6.8  
7.0  
7.1  
7.2  
7.3  
Miscellaneous..................................................127 Table 21: Programming Four Digit Account  
Numbers........................................................ 35  
Cross Point Parameters..................................128  
RADXAXS .....................................................131  
Door Profile.....................................................131  
Strike Profile....................................................133  
Event Profile....................................................134  
Table 22: Programming Ten Digit Account  
Numbers........................................................ 35  
Table 23: Verify Time................................................... 37  
Table 24: CF### Custom Function Keystrokes........ 52  
Table 25: Command Center Programming  
Choices .......................................................... 53  
Programming Prompts Directory ...........................136  
Table 26: Authority Level Selections .......................... 59  
Table 27: L## Secure Door-Door Mode  
Figures  
Definitions..................................................... 62  
Figure 1: Pager Display Fields.......................................25  
Figure 2: Account Number Entry .................................36  
Figure 3: User Group 122 Example..............................74  
Figure 4: Example Opening Window Timeline (using  
two Opening Windows on same day)..........97  
Table 28: BSFK User Code Report............................. 74  
Table 29: P### BFSK/Relay Codes/Relays.............. 93  
Table 30: Point Text for Points 240 to 247................. 93  
Table 31: Window Selections....................................... 95  
Figure 5: COMMAND 43 Flow Chart.......................117  
Figure 6: RAM IP Address Prompts...........................118  
Table 32: Programming for Two Same Day Opening  
Windows (see Figure 4)................................. 98  
Table 33: Programming to Link Two Days over  
Midnight........................................................ 98  
Figure 7: Com Port Selection within  
HyperTerminal.............................................120  
Table 34: W# Close Window Stop Programming  
Example......................................................... 99  
Figure 8: External Modem Connection .....................120  
Figure 9: Path # IP Add1 to Add4 .............................123  
Figure 10: Poll Rate Timeline......................................124  
Table 35: Opening/Closing Windows Worksheet... 101  
Table 36: Opening/Closing Windows....................... 101  
Table 37: Normal Store Hours*................................. 101  
Table 38: Delivery Schedule*..................................... 102  
Table 39: Monthly Auditor’s Schedule*.................... 102  
Table 40: Cross Point Ranges Within Groups ......... 128  
Tables  
Table 1: Literature Referenced .....................................5  
Table 2: Differences between the D9412G and  
D7412G............................................................5  
Table 3: New Features...................................................6  
Table 4: Product Handlers............................................8  
Table 5: Programming Error Displays.........................9  
Table 6: Modem IIIa2 Communication Format Data -  
User ID Numbers..........................................13  
Table 7: Modem IIIa2 Communication Format Data –  
Point Numbers ..............................................13  
Table 8: Zones ..............................................................13  
Table 9: Diagnostic Reports........................................18  
Table 10: Burglar Reports.............................................18  
Table 11: User Reports..................................................19  
Table 12: Test Reports...................................................20  
Table 13: Diagnostic Reports........................................21  
Table 14: Relay Reports................................................21  
Table 15: Auto-Function Reports.................................21  
Table 16: RAM Reports................................................22  
Table 17: Point Reports.................................................22  
Table 18: User Change Reports ...................................23  
Table 19: Access Reports ..............................................23  
Table 20: Event Descriptions, Priorities, and  
Numbers.........................................................26  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 5  
1.3  
Differences Between the D9412G  
and D7412G  
1.0 Introduction  
Table 2 describes the differences between the D9412G  
and the D7412G Control Panels.  
1.1  
How to use this Program Entry Guide  
This guide addresses the programming of the  
D9412G/D7412G Control Panels only, and should not  
be used in conjunction with other control panels.  
Table 2: Differences between the D9412G and  
D7412G  
Although this guide specifically refers to the D9412G  
Control Panels, it can be used for programming the  
D7412G Control Panels. Differences between the  
D9412G and D7412G are shown Table 2.  
Features  
Access Control  
D9412G  
Yes  
Eight Doors  
D7412G  
Yes  
Two Doors  
1.2  
Literature Referenced  
Expanded users  
Throughout this guide, references are made to other  
documents. See Table 1 for a part numbers list of the  
referenced literature for ordering purposes.  
Arm/disarm  
Passcodes  
Cards/tokens  
249  
996  
99  
396  
Read the following documents before installing and  
programming the products.  
Passcode-protected  
custom functions  
16  
4
Number of printers  
Number of points  
Number of relays  
3
246  
128  
1
75  
64  
Table 1: Literature Referenced  
Document Name  
Part Number  
74-06819-000  
74-06925-000  
1. D1255 Installation Instructions  
2. D1256/D1257 Installation  
Instructions  
3. D1260 Installation Guide  
4. D1260 Owner’s Manual  
5. D5200 Operations Manual  
6. D6500 Report Directory  
48101  
50410  
74-06176-000  
74-04651-001  
39963  
7. D6600 Communications  
Receiver/Gateway Computer  
Interface Manual  
8. D720 Installation Instructions  
74-06918-000  
32206  
9. D9210B Operation and  
Installation Guide  
10. D9210B Program Entry Guide  
32207  
11. D9210B Program Record Sheet 32208  
12. D9412G/D7412G Operation  
and Installation Guide  
43488  
47488  
38849  
13. D9412G/D7412G Program  
Record Sheet  
14. RPS Operations Manual  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 6  
1.4  
New Features  
The items shown Table 3 are new features added to the D9412G/D7412G Control Panels since version 6.10.  
Table 3: New Features  
Feature  
Description  
Ground Fault Detect  
(Version 6.10)  
For the D9412G/D7412G to detect ground fault conditions, the earth ground terminal on the  
control panel was electrically isolated from all other terminals. A ground fault detect enable switch  
(S4) was added to the control panel and is located under Terminal 10, earth ground. For more  
information on the operation of this function, see the D9412G/D7412G Operation and Installation  
Guide (P/N: 43488).  
Added Feature when  
Using Ground Fault  
Detect (Version 6.10)  
When ground fault detect is enabled (S4 closed), Points 1 to 8 can be used for non-powered fire-  
initiating devices; such as, heat detectors, 4-wire smoke detectors, or pull stations. A D125B  
Powered Loop Interface or a D129 Dual Class A Interface Module is no longer required when  
connecting non-powered fire-initiating devices to Points 1 to 8.  
Fire Supervision Restoral  
Event (Version 6.20)  
A new Fire Supervision Restoral Event was added to the Fire Events route group allowing this  
event to be transmitted when a Fire Supervision point restores to normal. Previous versions sent  
either a Fire Alarm Restore or Fire Trouble Restore Event.  
AC Fail Time modification  
(Version 6.20)  
The AC Fail Time entry was modified to allow additional programming flexibility. In previous  
versions, the AC Fail Time was made in either minutes or seconds (depending on the firmware  
version). However, version 6.20 allows you to select minutes or seconds and the length of time the  
AC Fail message is delayed (6 hours or 12 hours) after the occurrence. See the AC Fail Time  
prompt in Section 2.5 Power Supervision for additional information.  
Fire Trouble Resound  
(Version 6.20)  
The D9412G and D7412G can be programmed to re-sound the fire trouble tone at command  
center(s) at midnight or at noon if the Fire point is still in a trouble condition. See the A # Silent  
Alarm prompt in Section 2.13.1 Area Relays for additional information.  
Perimeter Armed Relay  
Operation (Version 6.20)  
The D9412G and D7412G can be programmed to activate a relay output when an area becomes  
Perimeter Armed using COMMAND 2 (Perimeter Instant), COMMAND 3 (Perimeter Delayed), or  
COMMAND 8 (Perimeter Partial). See the A # Silent Alarm prompt in Section 2.13.1 Area Relays  
for additional programming information.  
Poll Rate Operation  
(Version 6.20)  
In versions 6.00 and 6.10, a poll rate can be programmed to supervise the connection between the  
control panel, D9133TTL-E, and the D6600 Receiver. If the supervision connection was lost, future  
events were still routed to the Primary Path first before attempting the Backup Path. In version 6.20,  
the ability to instruct the control panel to automatically use the Backup Path if the Primary Path is  
compromised was added.  
Programming Account  
Numbers (Version 6.20)  
The 9000MAIN version 1.12 handler and version 6.20 firmware and higher now can program a  
four-digit or ten-digit account number for each area. See the A# Acct Number prompt in Section  
2.9 Area Parameters for additional programming information.  
Cross Point Operation  
(Version 6.30)  
The D9412G and D7412G can now be programmed to group multiple points together in a Cross  
Point configuration mode. This feature, more commonly known as Cross Zoning, instructs the  
control panel to delay its alarm response for a programmed period of time before additional points  
go into an alarm condition, verifying the burglar alarm condition. To program the D9412G or  
D7412G for Cross Point operation, review the following:  
Location  
Item  
Table 10  
R# Unverified Evt  
Cross Point prompt  
Cross Point prompt  
Section 4.1.1 Point Responses  
Section 6.8 Cross Point Parameters  
D1260 Alpha V Command The new D1260 Alpha V Command Center boasts an easy-to-read, four-line by twenty-character  
Center Support (Version  
6.30)  
LCD display, eight soft keys for displaying simple selections, and the standard Bosch Security  
Systems command structure (COMMAND 1, COMMAND 2, and so on). See the Enhanced  
Command Center prompt in Section 2.10.1 Cmd Cntr (Command Center) Assignment for further  
programming information.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 7  
Table 3: continued  
Feature  
Description  
Fire Trouble Resound  
Mode (Version 6.30)  
To help our Bosch Security Systems dealers program this feature more easily, the prompt, Fire  
Trouble Resound was added to Section 6.7 Miscellaneous.  
Sked Functions (Version  
6.30)  
The D9412G and D7412G can be programmed to execute Sked 28 (Expanded Off-Normal Test  
Reports) and Sked 29 (Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Reports). These new skeds allow the  
control panel to generate Expanded or Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report Event instead of the  
previously used Expanded Test Report or Non-Expanded Test Report Event. See the S## Function  
Code prompt, 28 and 29, in Section 5.2 Skeds for further programming information.  
Inovonics Premises RF  
Compatibility  
(Version 6.30)  
In version 6.30 you can add Inovonics Premises RF. Through the use of the D8125INV Wireless  
Interface, which connects directly to ZONEX 1 and ZONEX 2 (D9412G only) and an Inovonics  
FA400 Wireless Receiver, up to 238 wireless transmitters can be added to a D9412G (up to 67  
can be added to the D7412G). Each D8125INV supports up to 119 wireless transmitters (or 67 if  
connected to a D7412G). Transmitters added to the system can be monitored for activation,  
tamper, and low battery conditions. The FA400 Receiver is also supervised and the Inovonics  
Repeaters can be programmed to be supervised.  
High Speed PSTN RPS  
Communications (Version  
6.30)  
Using an off-the-shelf modem (capable of communicating at 9600-baud) and a D9133DC Direct  
Connect Programming Module, RPS can now communicate with a D9412G or D7412G at 9600-  
baud instead of using the on-board 300 baud modem chip. This is especially useful for those  
accounts requiring constant RPS communication sessions, such as passcode or token changes or  
copying the logger. The use of this feature dramatically reduces the time (and money) spent online  
with the control panel. See Section 6.4.2 Using an External Modem for programming details on the  
operation of this feature.  
New Buzz On Fault Mode  
(Version 6.30)  
A Buzz on Fault Mode (Option 3) was added to the point index parameters. For points with Option  
3 enabled, a trouble tone is generated at the keypad when the point is off-normal while the area is  
disarmed. The user (by either passcode or COMMAND 4) cannot silence this buzz. It silences  
automatically when the point restores. Apply this feature when you want to monitor specific points  
and produce an audible annunciation at the command center when the point is faulted. For  
example, this feature could be used for a driveway sensor or a vestibule door that alerts you to an  
approaching individual.  
Disarm Now message  
enhancement (Version  
6.30)  
The DISARM NOWtext that appears during entry delay was modified beginning with version 6.30.  
The new text that appears alternates between DISARM NOWand the point text of the point that  
caused the area to go into entry delay. For example, if the point causing the area to go into entry  
delay was named Front Office Dr, then the control panel displays DISARM NOWthen FRONT  
OFFICE DR during the entirety of entry delay.  
Panel Buzzer (Version  
6.30  
Beginning with version 6.3 and higher, the control panel’s on-board buzzer pulses 1 second on, 1  
second off, if a supervised command center no longer responds to polls from the control panel. The  
buzzer is silenced when the supervised command center begins responding to polls again or when  
[COMMAND][4] is entered from an operational command center.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 8  
1.5  
Product Handlers  
Programming the 9000 Series requires multiple product handlers. The availability of each handler is indicated in  
Table 4. See the control panel specific Release Notes to determine the most up-to-date handler versions.  
Although the handlers shown in Table 4 can be used to program any of the new control panels, not all of the  
functions operate. For example, the RADXUSR1 Handler is used to program users 000 through 124. Even though  
the handler allows you to program users 100 through 124, the D7412G does not allow the activation of these  
users.  
Table 4: Product Handlers  
Product Handler Function  
D9412G  
D7412G  
9000MAIN  
Covers Panel-Wide, Area, Command Center Function List, User  
Interface, and Relay programming modules.  
RADXUSR1  
Covers Passcode/Token programming for Users 000 through 124  
(99 users for the D7412G).  
RADXUSR2  
RADXPNTS  
RADXSKED  
Covers Passcode/Token programming for Users 125 through 249.  
Covers Point Index and Point Assignment programming for all points.  
Covers Open/Close Windows, User Access Windows, Skeds, and  
Holiday Index programming modules.  
N/A  
RADXAUX1  
RADXAXS  
Covers SDI Automation, SDI RAM Parameters, Enhanced  
Communication Parameters, Route Group Attempts, Miscellaneous,  
and Cross Point Parameters.  
Covers the programming parameters for installed D9210B Door  
Controllers. The Program Entry Guide and Program Record Sheet for  
this handler comes with the D9210B Access Control Module.  
shipped with the control panel to determine  
which prompts must be programmed.  
1.6  
Programming Options  
This Program Entry Guide is set up in a specific order.  
Related program entries are grouped together in  
modules as they appear in the specific product  
handlers. The handler and the programming module  
are listed at the top of each page to help you find  
specific programming prompts.  
Program Entry Selections: Only the selections  
listed can be used for a particular program item.  
The programmer does not accept inappropriate  
entries.  
Program Entry Description: Provides concise  
information regarding what can occur with the  
various entry selections. Read the descriptions  
carefully to avoid improperly programmed  
equipment.  
This Program Entry Guide shows the programming  
options for each product handler. Each option is  
listed with:  
The Program Item Prompt: Each prompt is  
shown, as it appears in the D5200 Programmer  
[see the D5200 Programmer Operations Manual  
(P/N: 74-06176-000)] or the Remote Account  
Manager [see the RPS Operations Manual (P/N:  
38849)]. Sometimes, for space considerations, a  
prompt must be abbreviated in the Programmer  
display. In these cases, the meaning of the  
prompt is explained below the prompt  
Custom Programming: A new feature of the  
D5200 Programmer is the option to select  
custom programming (Yes or No) to expand  
programming modules within the D5200.  
Programming Custom as Yes does not affect a  
parameter’s programming. It allows parameters  
for special applications to be visible in the  
programmer.  
Program Entry Default Setting: Because  
defaults are set for the typical installation, you  
may not need to program each prompt. Review  
the default entries in the Program Record Sheet  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 9  
1.7  
Programming the Control Panel  
with the D5200 Programmer  
Latch the jumper in the upper right hand corner of  
the control panel labeled as RESET on the PCB and  
Reset Pin on the faceplate.  
Connect the molex end of the cord to the connector  
labeled PROG on the PCB and PROG CONN on  
the faceplate.  
Always initiate a control panel copy at the  
NEWRECORDor FILENAMEdisplay when pressing  
the [RECV] (copy) key of the D5200.  
Always initiate a control panel load at the  
FILENAME prompt or set as factory default at the  
NEWRECORD prompt when pressing the [SEND]  
(load) key.  
Disconnect the D5200 before releasing the reset pin.  
Do not leave the D5200 connected to the  
PROG connector without latching the  
RESET pin. Doing so causes SDI ##  
TROUBLEand CALL FOR SERVICEto  
display on the command centers. Door  
controllers also activate depending upon  
the SDI failure DIP switch setting.  
Table 5: Programming Error Displays  
Display  
Description  
INCOMPATIBLE PANEL  
You are connected to the  
wrong control panel or  
using the wrong handler.  
Check the faceplate for the  
model number and the  
handler title.  
CHECK CORD/RESET  
PIN  
Check the cord and reset  
pin  
0101  
01  
0101  
There is a 5 second to 25 second pause  
after the reset pin is unlatched during  
which the control panel scans all the  
points and properly displays, logs, and  
reports them.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 1.0 Introduction  
EN | 10  
Notes:  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 11  
The control panel is pre-programmed with a  
7-second dial tone detect period. When a dial tone is  
detected or the waiting period ends, the control  
panel begins to dial. To extend the dial tone detect  
period, place a D before the phone number. To  
insert a pause during or after dialing, use C in the  
number sequence. For example, if the control panel  
hangs up before it hears the Modem IIIa2 Ack tone  
from the D6500/D6600, program extra Cs after the  
phone number. The control panel waits on line for  
three extra seconds for each C programmed.  
2.0 9000MAIN  
Use this programming module to define the  
operating characteristics that affect panel-wide  
functions. There are nine programming categories in  
this module: Phone, Phone Parameters, Routing,  
Enhanced Communications, Area Parameters,  
Command Center, User Interface, Function List, and  
Relay Parameters.  
2.1  
Phone  
Enter up to 24 of the following characters to define  
dialing characteristics.  
The control panel can dial up to four different  
telephone numbers when sending event reports. All  
telephone numbers use the same receiver format.  
Event report routing and communication protocols  
are discussed in Section 2.3 Routing.  
0101  
Using both phone data entry lines: The first  
01  
line of the phone number data entry line  
must be filled (twelve characters) before  
you press [ENTER] to move on to the  
second line. If you enter characters on the  
second line, and there are less than twelve  
characters on the first line, the second line  
clears when you press [ENTER].  
0101  
Phone 1  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Up to 24 characters (do not enter  
[SPACE])  
Phone 2  
0 to 9  
C
Numbers 0 through 9  
3-second pause  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Up to 24 characters (do not enter  
[SPACE])  
D
7-second dial-tone detect.  
# or *  
Used for the same purpose as pressing  
this key on a telephone keypad when  
manually dialing. For example, an  
asterisk (*) may be needed to access  
your long distance service. Do not use  
these characters when pulse dialing.  
See explanation of Phone 1. This number is Phone  
2, referred to in the prompts in Section 2.3 Routing.  
Phone 3  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Up to 24 characters (do not enter  
[SPACE])  
Blank  
Control panel dials no phone number.  
Programming this item Blank does not  
disable phone routing. To disable  
reporting to this phone, see Section 2.3  
Routing.  
See explanation of Phone 1. This number is Phone  
3, referred to in the prompts in Section 2.3 Routing.  
Phone 4  
This is the telephone number the control panel dials  
to contact the central station receiver when sending  
event reports. This number is Phone 1 referred to in  
the prompts in Section 2.3 Routing.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Up to 24 characters (do not enter  
[SPACE])  
See explanation of Phone 1. This number is Phone  
4, referred to in the prompts in Section 2.3 Routing.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 12  
2.2  
Phone Parameters  
Point/User Flag  
The program items in this category describe panel-  
wide characteristics for telephone dialing, receiver  
format, and supervision.  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Modem Format  
Yes  
The control panel sends a flag with  
each report telling the D6500/D6600 to  
convert point numbers and User ID  
numbers to COMEX format. The  
conversions are shown in Table 6 and  
Table 7. No matter how the  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Radionics’ Modem IIIa2  
Communication Format: Reports  
identify points as 001 through 247 and  
passcode User ID codes as 000 through  
249 at the D6500/D6600 Receiver  
(unless Point/User Flag is  
programmed Yes; see the Point/User  
Flag prompt in this section). When  
reporting point events, Radionics’  
Modem IIIa2 Communication Format  
also sends point text to the  
D6500/D6600 is programmed for  
output to the computer system, points  
and User ID numbers are converted  
when this item is Yes. (See the D6600  
Communications Receiver/Gateway  
Computer Interface Manual, Appendix C,  
Numbered Table and Note 1.)  
No  
The control panel does not send the  
flag. The D6500/D6600 outputs point  
numbers as 001 to 247 (rather than 100  
to 732) and User ID numbers as 000 to  
249 (rather than 000 to F08), as  
D6500/D6600 as programmed in Point  
Assignments.  
No  
BFSK (2300 Hz or 1400 Hz  
acknowledgment tone).  
indicated in Table 6 and Table 7.  
This program item determines how point and User  
ID numbers are presented at the D6500/D6600  
display, printer, and computer RS-232 output.  
Central Station Receiver Format for  
Transmission of Reports: Modem format provides  
many reporting advantages over the BFSK format.  
See the D6500/D6600 Report Directory for more  
information about the effect of reporting formats.  
When Modem Format is Yes, the control panel  
sends expanded Radionics’ Modem IIIa2  
Communication Format reports to the  
D6500/D6600. If your central station data files are  
not set up for point and User ID number reporting,  
you can use this program item to convert these  
numbers to COMEX Reports.  
Modem Format must be set to Yes when  
sending events over a network to a D6600  
receiver (NetCom).  
0101  
When Modem Format is Yes, the control panel  
If Modem Format is No, be sure to assign  
01  
sends expanded Radionics’ Modem IIIa2  
a number to identify Duress Reports in  
BFSK Duress Code in this programming  
section.  
0101  
Communication Format Reports to the receiver.  
Point/User Flag affects Radionics’ Modem IIIa2  
Communication Format data as shown in Table 6.  
The Bosch Security Systems D6500/D6600 Receiver  
adds the leading zero in the User ID number with  
Point/User Flag programmed No.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 13  
D6000: Opening/Closing User ID numbers are  
identified at the receiver as ZONEs (same  
identification as independent points).  
Table 6: Modem IIIa2 Communication Format  
Data - User ID Numbers  
Table 8: Zones  
Point/User Flag  
NO  
000  
Point/User Flag  
YES  
000  
User ID Number  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Zone  
B
C
D
E
F
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
0
001 to 005  
006 to 013  
014 to 021  
022 to 029  
030 to 037  
038 to 045  
046 to 053  
054 to 061  
062 to 069  
070 to 249  
001 to 005  
601 to 608  
701 to 708  
801 to 808  
B01 to B08  
C01 to C08  
D01 to D08  
E01 to E08  
F01 to F08  
000  
8
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
Table 7: Modem IIIa2 Communication Format  
Data – Point Numbers  
D6500/D6600 Receiving BFSK Format:  
Opening/closing User ID numbers are identified at  
the receiver as ZN (same identification as  
independent points). The ZN numbers are based on  
the tens digit of the User ID number. This only  
applies for Users 000 through 099. Users 100  
through 249 do not report in BFSK format.  
Point/User Flag  
NO  
Point/User Flag  
YES  
001 to 008  
009 to 024  
025 to 040  
041 to 056  
057 to 072  
073 to 088  
089 to 104  
105 to 120  
121 to 136  
153 to 168  
169 to 184  
185 to 200  
201 to 216  
217 to 232  
233 – 247  
100 to 800  
101 to 116  
201 to 216  
301 to 316  
401 to 416  
501 to 516  
601 to 616  
701 to 716  
801 to 816  
217 to 232  
317 to 332  
417 to 432  
517 to 532  
617 to 632  
717 to 731  
DTMF Dialing  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Dials the programmed phone  
number(s) using DTMF.  
No  
Pulse dialing only.  
Use dual-tone multi-frequency (DTMF) to dial the  
central station receiver phone number(s) for event  
reports, and/or the RPS.  
Independent Zone Control Notice: When using  
Independent Zone Controls (IZC) to send  
Opening/Closing Reports by point, do not duplicate  
reporting independent point numbers with User ID  
Reports (see Section 3.1 Passcode/Token Worksheet). For  
example: If an IZC is connected to Point 8, User ID  
8 should not be used.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 14  
Phone Supv Time  
Buzz on Fail  
Default:  
Blank  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Blank or 10 to 240  
No phone line supervision.  
Yes or No  
Blank  
Yes  
Generate panel-wide trouble tones and  
display PHONE FAIL #at command  
centers when a Phone Fail Event  
occurs.  
10 to 240  
Enter the number of seconds (in 10  
second increments) you wish to  
supervise the phone line. After a faulted  
phone line restores, it takes the same  
amount of time to initiate restoral  
responses.  
No  
Does not generate trouble tones at  
command centers when a Phone Fail  
Event occurs. PHONE FAIL #still  
displays.  
Phone line trouble responses: Command centers  
display SERVC PH LINE #to indicate which  
phone line failed. The command center initiates a  
trouble tone if Buzz on Fail is Yes and CC Trouble  
Tone is Yes.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Phone Supv Time must be programmed to  
use this feature.  
With dual phone lines (using the D928 Module), the  
restored phone line handles all messages regardless  
of the phone line’s number.  
De-selecting individual command  
centers for panel-wide trouble tones:  
Panel-wide trouble tones for programming  
CC can turn off individual command  
centers (based on their CC # 1 through 8)  
# Trouble Tone in Command Center  
Parameters as No.  
Phone, Trouble, and Restoral Events report when  
they occur. They report also when a Diagnostic  
Report is initiated from a command center or by a  
Sked.  
Alarm On Fail  
Two Phone Lines  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Generate alarm responses when a  
phone line fails.  
Yes  
The D928 Dual Phone Line Module is  
installed. The LEDs on the D928 light  
to indicate primary or secondary line  
trouble and COMM FAIL.  
No  
Phone failures report as trouble  
responses for Area 1 and/or the  
account number for Area 1.  
No  
No D928 Dual Phone Line Module.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Use this program item when a D928 Dual Phone  
Line Module is connected to the control panel. Both  
lines must operate the same; either ground start or  
loop start.  
Phone Supv Time must be programmed to  
use this feature.  
0101  
Phone Failure Alarm Responses: The  
Alarm Bell relay for Area 1 activates. All  
Phone Event messages report as Area 1  
and/or the account number for Area 1.  
01  
IMPORTANT! Program Phone Supv Time  
when using two phone lines.  
0101  
NFPA standards prohibit the use of ground  
start phone lines in systems monitoring  
Fire points.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 15  
Press the [SPACE] bar to scroll through the  
selections. Press [ENTER] when the correct selection  
appears in the display.  
BFSK Duress Code  
Default:  
0
Use this program item only when the control  
panel is connected to ground start  
telephone lines. Ground start is not allowed  
on UL Listed systems.  
Selection:  
0 to 9  
If Duress Enable in Area Parameters is Yes and  
Modem Format in Phone Parameters is No, you  
must program a number to identify Duress Reports  
at the central station.  
2.3  
Routing  
Use routing to select full or partial groups of events  
which report to up to four different destinations.  
Routing includes choosing the most important  
destination (route number), the events reported to a  
single or multiple destination, and if the events fail,  
selecting a backup destination.  
Expand Test Rpt  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Report events listed in Routing Group  
Test Reports report to the central  
station if they are off-normal.  
2.3.1 Called Party Disconnect  
Telephone companies provide called party  
disconnect to allow the called party to terminate a  
call. The called party must go on hook (hang up) for  
a fixed interval before a dial tone is available for a  
new call. This interval varies with telephone  
company equipment. D9412G/D7412G firmware  
allows for called party disconnect by adding a 35  
second on hook interval to the dial tone detect  
function. If the control panel does not detect a dial  
tone in 7 seconds, it puts the phone line on hook for  
35 seconds to activate called party disconnect, goes  
off hook and begins a 7-second dial tone detect. If  
no dial tone is detected, the control panel dials the  
number anyway. Each time the number is dialed,  
the control panel records this as an attempt. After  
ten attempts, the control panel goes into  
Does not report off-normal conditions  
for the events listed in the Routing  
Group Test Reports at test time.  
Use this program item to add system event  
information to scheduled Test Reports. Test Reports  
are set up as scheduled events. See Section 5.2 Skeds.  
This parameter is related only to Sked  
Function Code 9 (Test Report) and  
whether this Sked transmits Expanded  
Test Report information or not. It does not  
have any bearing on Sked Function Codes  
28 (Expanded Off-Normal Test Report)  
and 29 (Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test  
Report).  
communications failure and Comm Fail Route #  
displays on the command centers.  
Ground Start  
2.3.2 Route Number Groups: Which Has the  
Highest Priority?  
Default:  
Long  
Selection:  
Long or Short  
To program a group, first choose a route number.  
The lower the route number, the higher priority that  
group has (for example, events reported for Route 1  
have a higher priority than Routes 2, 3, or 4 if each  
group tries to send a message at the same time). This  
becomes important when programming duplicate  
reports or choosing the events you want to ensure  
report first regardless of the number of events that  
need to report to multiple groups. Route 1 group  
primary device is the first destination the control  
panel attempts to dial if an event in that group must  
be reported. If the control panel is idle, any event  
generated for any group initiates a dialing sequence.  
Long  
Standard duration of ground. Use this  
setting for most ground start telephone  
systems. The duration is 700  
milliseconds.  
Short  
Shorter duration of ground. Use this  
setting for telephone systems where  
specified. The duration is 250  
milliseconds.  
Some newer ground start telephone exchange  
switches require a shorter amount of time to initiate  
dial tone. If the control panel cannot initiate a dial  
tone on the ground start line with the default (long)  
setting, try the short setting.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 16  
2.3.6 Routing Destination Communication  
2.3.3 Programming a Primary and Backup  
Destination  
Failures  
Each route number has an R# Primary Device and  
an R# Backup Device. In typical applications  
where two phone numbers are programmed, the R#  
Primary Device destination is the phone number  
the route group attempts to dial first. If the R#  
Primary Device destination fails to connect to the  
central station receiver after two dialing attempts, the  
R# Backup Device destination is dialed. In  
addition, the control panel can be programmed so  
the R# Primary Device and/or the R# Backup  
Device can be an SDI device, such as a D9133TTL-  
E Network Interface Module. The control panel can  
also be programmed to make only one attempt for  
the R# Primary Device before attempting to send  
events using the R# Backup Device.  
When the R# Primary Device fails to connect with  
the central station after one or two attempts (see  
RG# 1 Attempt in Section 6.6.1 Route Group  
Attempts), the R# Backup Device phone number or  
SDI Path is attempted. The central station receives  
the original event with a COMM FAIL PHONE# =  
(1, 2, 3, or 4) if the R# Primary Device destination  
is a phone number. If the R# Primary Device is an  
SDI Path, the central station receives the original  
event with A COMM FAIL RG# SDI## (SDI Path  
1 = 88, SDI Path 2 = 89, SDI Path 3 = 90, SDI Path  
4 = 91). When all attempts to both the R# Primary  
Device and R# Backup Device fail, a Comm Fail  
RG# Event is generated. Comm Restore Events are  
not generated.  
2.3.4 Enhanced Routing  
2.3.7 Message Prioritization within a Route  
Number  
In previous versions, only Phone numbers 1 through  
4 could be programmed for the Primary and Backup  
Destinations. The D9412G/D7412G allow events to  
be transmitted to up to four additional SDI Paths.  
The D9133TTL-E Network Interface Module (with  
Ethernet) connects directly to the SDI Bus and  
occupies SDI Address 88. For additional information  
regarding the specific programming requirements for  
enhanced communications, see Sections 2.4 Enhanced  
Routing and 6.5 Enhanced Communications.  
The D9412G/D7412G Control Panels meet the  
digital reporting requirements for UL 864. Fire  
Alarm Events have the highest priority and are  
reported first for each group. The next highest  
priority events are in the following order: panic,  
duress, medical, intrusion alarm, supervisory, and all  
troubles and restorals.  
0101  
To comply with NFPA and UL864, you  
01  
must program Route 1 to report only Fire  
Alarm Events to ensure the fastest  
reporting time.  
0101  
2.3.5 Programming a Duplicate Report  
To allow an event within a group to report to  
multiple groups, the event should be Yes for each  
route number available. For instance, programming  
Fire Alarms for Route Group 1 and Route Group 2  
results in the fire alarms first reporting to Route  
Group 1 followed by a duplicate report to Route  
Group 2.  
2.3.8 Dialing Attempts  
The D9412G/D7412G Control Panels have a  
prompt called RG# 1 Attempt (see Section 6.6.1  
Route Group Attempts.).  
If this item is set to No, the control panel first makes  
up to six attempts to make contact using the primary  
device within a route group. If unsuccessful, it makes  
up to four attempts to make contact using the  
backup device before initiating a Comm Fail Report.  
When only one destination is programmed, the  
control panel makes ten attempts to contact that  
destination. Each group takes approximately 10  
minutes to go into Comm Fail.  
If this item is set to Yes, the control panel only  
makes one attempt (instead of two) to contact the  
primary device before attempting to contact the  
backup device. The route group still makes a total of  
ten attempts; however, the R# Primary Device  
makes five attempts and then the R# Backup  
Device makes five attempts.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 17  
Route #  
R# Backup Device  
Default:  
1
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Selection:  
1 to 4  
Blank, 1 to 4  
1
2
3
4
First group sent  
Second group sent  
Third group sent  
Fourth group sent  
1
2
3
4
Phone 1 or SDI Path 1 is this group’s  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Phone 2 or SDI Path 2 is this group’s  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Enter the number specifying the route group to  
program. The route represents the group you wish to  
send a group of reports. The groups are prioritized. 1  
is the first group to report and 4 is the last group to  
report. Each group has a primary and a backup  
device. The primary device is the first (most  
important) destination used to reach the  
Phone 3 or SDI Path 3 is this group’s  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
Phone 4 or SDI Path 4 is this group’s  
backup destination if the primary  
destination fails.  
programmed route within this group. The backup  
device is used if the primary device fails.  
Enter the number specifying the backup device. The  
backup device is used when the primary device fails  
to reach the programmed destination.  
R# Primary Device  
Default:  
Blank  
View Events?  
Selection:  
Blank, 1 to 4  
Default:  
No  
1
2
3
4
Phone 1 or SDI Path 1 is this group’s  
primary destination.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Access each routing group and  
program individual events for this  
route group only (D5200).  
Phone 2 or SDI Path 2 is this group’s  
primary destination.  
Phone 3 or SDI Path 3 is this group’s  
primary destination.  
Continue programming without  
viewing individual groups.  
Phone 4 or SDI Path 4 is this group’s  
primary destination.  
The D5200 Programmer reveals the following sub-  
prompts. Leaving View Events? as No allows the  
user to ignore a large area of programming that  
might not need to be changed.  
Enter the number specifying the primary device.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 18  
Fire Reports  
Burglar Reports  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Selecting Yes enables sending a report when the  
event occurs.  
Table 9: Diagnostic Reports  
Table 10: Burglar Reports  
Report  
Selections Description  
Report  
Selections Description  
R# Alarm  
Report Burglar Alarm  
Event.  
Reports non-fire  
restoral from trouble,  
missing, or  
supervisory.  
Duress Report.  
Reports missing  
Alarm point.  
Reports user code  
tamper.  
Reports Trouble  
Event.  
Reports Missing  
Trouble Event.  
Reports Non-fire  
Supervision Event.  
Reports point bus  
failure.  
Reports restoral of  
point bus after failure.  
Reports canceled  
non-fire alarm.  
Yes, No  
R# Fire Alarm  
R# Fire Restore  
(Alarm)  
Reports Fire Event.  
Reports fire restoral  
from alarm.  
Reports missing Fire  
point.  
Reports fire trouble.  
Reports fire  
supervision.  
Reports fire restoral  
from trouble,  
missing, or bypass.  
Reports canceled  
fire alarm.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Burg  
Restore  
Yes, No  
R# Fire Missing  
Yes, No  
R# Fire Trouble  
R# Fire  
Supervis  
R# Fire Restore  
(T/M/S)  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Duress  
R# Missing  
Alarm  
R# Usr Code  
Tmpr  
R# Trouble Rpt  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Fire Cancel  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Missing Trbl  
R# Fire Sup  
Miss  
Report fire  
supervisory missing.  
Reports restorals  
from Fire  
Supervision.  
R# Non Fire  
Suprv  
R# Pt Bus Fail  
R# Fire Supv  
Rest*  
* This event is not reported when using BFSK format.  
R# Pt Bus Rstl  
R# Non Fire  
Cncl  
R# Alarm  
Restore  
Reports non-fire  
restoral from alarm.  
R# Sup Missing  
Reports supervisory  
missing.  
Reports Unverified  
Events for Cross  
points.  
R# Unverfied  
Evt†*  
† This event is not reported when using BFSK format.  
* This event does not produce a corresponding Restoral  
Event.  
0101  
The Unverified Event is transmitted when a  
01  
single point programmed in Cross Point  
Group faults into an alarm condition then  
restores before the Cross Point Time  
elapses. This event encompasses both  
Fire and Non-fire points. It is not, however,  
related to the Verify Time used for smoke  
detectors.  
0101  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 19  
Restoral Reports are not sent if the  
control panel is reset after a point is  
bypassed and then the point is  
unbypassed. This is true for both Fire and  
Non-fire points.  
User Reports  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Table 11: User Reports  
The 9000 Series Control Panels log a  
Ground Fault Event as Trouble Point 256.  
Report  
R# Point  
Bypass  
R# Forced  
Point  
R# Point Open  
R# Point Close  
R# Forced Arm  
Selections Description  
Reports Point  
Bypass Event.  
Reports Forced  
Point Event.  
Reports Point  
Opening Event.  
Reports Point  
Closing Event.  
Reports point forced  
armed.  
Reports Fail to  
Open Event.  
Reports Fail to  
Close Event.  
Reports Extend  
Close Time Event.  
Reports Opening  
Events.  
Reports Point  
Forced Close Event  
Reports Closing  
Events.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Fail To  
Open  
R# Fail To  
Close  
R# Ext Clos Tm  
R# Opening  
Rpt  
R# Forced  
Close  
R# Closing Rpt  
R# FC Perim  
Inst  
Reports Forced  
Close Perimeter  
Instant Armed Event.  
R# FC Perim  
Delay  
Reports Forced  
Close Perimeter  
Delay Armed Event.  
Yes, No  
R# Perim Inst  
Arm  
R# Perim Delay  
Arm  
R# Send User  
Text  
Reports Perimeter  
Instant Armed Event.  
Reports Perimeter  
Delay Armed Event.  
Reports user text.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 20  
Test Reports  
Table 12: Test Reports  
0101  
To send a single Test Report (R# Test  
Report), enable Sked Function Code #9  
01  
Report  
R# S: Alarm  
R# S: Trouble  
Selections Description  
0101  
(Test Report) in the Skeds section of the  
program.  
Status Alarm Report  
Status Trouble  
Report  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
To expand this Test Report to include any  
off-normal point condition or other off-  
normal conditions of events listed in Diag  
Reports as a Non-status Event following a  
Test Report, Expand Test Rpt in Section  
2.2 Phone Parameters must be  
R# S:  
Supervised  
Status Supervised  
Report  
Status Report  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Status  
Report  
R# S: Open  
R# S: Close  
R# Test Report  
R# S: Perim  
Inst  
R# S: Perim  
Delay  
Status Open Report  
Status Close Report  
Test Report  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
programmed Yes.  
Events R# Log Threshold, R# Log  
Overflow, and R# RAM Fail are added to  
the reports sent with Expanded Test  
Reports if they are enabled in RAM Reports  
and Expand Test Rpt is also enabled.  
Status Perimeter  
Instant Arm Report  
Status Perimeter  
Delay Arm Report  
Status Fire  
Supervision Report  
Status Fire Alarm  
Report  
Status Fire Trouble  
Report  
Status Fire Missing  
Report  
Status Burg Missing  
Trouble Report  
Status Burg Missing  
Alarm Report  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
To initiate a Status Report, which includes  
all R# S: ____ Events as a Status Event (as  
opposed to a Non-status Event), Sked  
Function Code #10 must be enabled in the  
Skeds section of the program.  
R# S: Fire Supv  
R# S: Fire  
Alarm  
R# S: Fire Trbl  
Reporting off-normal conditions as a Status  
Report following a Test Report is required  
by some automation systems. Reporting off-  
normal conditions as a Non-status Report,  
which follows a Test Report, is required for  
other automation systems.  
R# S: Msng  
Fire  
R# S:  
MsngBurgTr  
R# S:  
MsngBurgAl  
R# S:  
FireSpMsng  
An off-normal condition is any point which is  
missing, trouble, supervisory, or in alarm (as  
opposed to normal). Also, points not  
cleared at the command center report as  
off-normal.  
Status Fire  
Supervision Missing  
Report  
R# S:  
SuperMsng  
Status Non-fire  
Supervision Missing  
Report  
Status Door Left  
Open Report  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Control Panels with Firmware version 6.30  
or higher can generate an Expanded Off-  
Normal Test Report by using Sked Function  
Code 28 or a Non-Expanded Off-Normal  
Test Report using Sked Function Code 29.  
To generate this event, one or more points  
must be in an off-normal state at the time  
the Sked executes. Expanded Off-Normal  
Test Reports include the Off Normal Test  
Report Event as well as events for any  
points that are in an off-normal state at the  
time the report is generated. Non-Expanded  
Off-Normal Test Report Events are only  
sent when a point is in the off-normal state  
but only sends the Off Normal Test Report  
Event.  
R# S:  
DrLeftOpen  
Diag Reports  
Selecting Yes enables sending a report when the  
event occurs. If the off-normal state of the following  
events (indicated with an *) still exist, they report  
when a Test Report (see the Test Reports sub-  
prompt in Section 2.3.8 Dialing Attempts) is initiated  
and Expanded Test Rpt is programmed Yes.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 21  
Relay Reports  
Table 13: Diagnostic Reports  
Selecting Yes enables sending a report when the  
event occurs.  
Report  
Selections Description  
Reports SDI device  
failure.  
Reports restoral of SDI  
device failure.  
Reports Watchdog  
Reset Event.  
Reports parameter  
checksum failure.  
Reports Reboot Event.  
R# SDI Dev Fail*  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Table 14: Relay Reports  
R# SDI Dev Restl  
Report  
Selections  
Description  
Reports Sensor  
Reset Event.  
Reports Relay  
Set Event.  
Reports Relay  
Reset Event.  
R# Watchdog  
Rset  
R#  
ParaChksmFail  
R# Reboot  
R# Sensor  
Reset  
Yes, No  
R# Relay Set  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Relay Reset  
Reports failure of phone  
line.  
R# Ph Line Fail*  
R# Ph Line Rstl  
Reports restoral of  
phone line after failure.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
When activating an on-board relay using  
PC9000, the 9000 Series Control Panel  
logs and prints the event as Relay 250  
(Relay A), Relay 251 (Relay B), and Relay  
252 (Relay C).  
Reports failure of AC  
power to control panel.  
Reports restoral of AC  
power to control panel  
after failure.  
R# AC Fail*  
R# AC Restorl  
Reports Battery Missing  
Detection Event.  
Reports low battery  
power.  
Reports restoral of  
battery power to control  
panel after Missing or  
Low Event.  
R# Batt Missing*  
R# Battery Low*  
R# Battery Rstl  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
AutoFunc Reports  
The following prompts support customized routing  
of Auto Function Reports. Selecting Yes enables a  
report to be sent when the event occurs.  
Table 15: Auto-Function Reports  
R# Rt Comm  
Fail*1  
R# Rt Comm Rstl  
Reports failure to send  
report to specific route.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Report  
R# Sked  
Executed  
R# Sked  
Changed  
R# Execute Fail  
Selections Description  
Reports restoral of  
communication to  
specific route after a  
failure.  
Reports Checksum Fail  
Event.  
Reports failure of  
network.  
Reports restoral of  
network.  
Reports Sked  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Executed Event.  
Reports Sked  
Changed Event.  
R# Checksum  
Fail  
R# Network Fail2  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Reports a Fail to  
Execute Event.  
R# Network  
Rest2  
R# Network  
Reports condition of  
network.  
Yes, No  
Cond2  
1
This event covers Comm Fail Route Group and Comm  
Fail Phone. If enabled, both events are sent; if disabled,  
neither event is sent.  
2
This event reserved for future use.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Only turn on Rt Comm Fail and Rt Comm  
Restore in one route group.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 22  
RAM Reports  
Point Reports  
Selecting Yes enables sending a report when the  
RAM Passcode Event occurs.  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
RAM Access Failcan indicate a  
wrong RAM passcode when  
Table 17: Point Reports  
communicating with the control panel, or a  
valid RAM session was terminated by a  
means other than a Good-bye or Reset-  
bye command. Remote Resetindicates  
a Reset-bye command issued from RAM,  
Bad Call to RAMindicates the control  
panel called RAM but was unable to  
connect.  
Report  
R# Service  
Start  
Selections Description  
Reports Service  
Walk Test Start  
Event.  
Yes, No  
R# Service End  
R# Fire Walk St  
Reports Service  
Walk Test End  
Event.  
Yes, No  
Reports Fire Walk  
Start event.  
Reports Fire Walk  
End Event.  
Reports Walk Test  
Start Event for Walk  
Test and Invisible  
Walk Test.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Table 16: RAM Reports  
R# Fire Walk  
End  
R# Walk Test  
St  
Report  
Selection  
s
Description  
R# Log  
Threshold  
R# Log  
Overflow  
Reports Event log  
threshold reached.  
Yes, No  
Reports Log is full,  
old events are  
overwritten.  
Yes, No  
R# Walk Test  
End  
Reports Walk Test  
End Event for Walk  
Test and Invisible  
Walk Test.  
Yes, No  
R# Para  
Changed  
Reports RAM  
Parameter Change  
Event.  
Yes, No  
R# Extra Point  
Reports Extra Point  
Event.  
Reports point text.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# RAM OK  
R# RAM Fail  
Reports Successful  
RAM Access Event.  
Reports Failed  
Access RAM Event.  
Reports Remote  
Reset Event.  
Reports Successful  
Laptop Access  
Event.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Send Point  
Text*  
R# RF Low Bat  
Reports low battery  
conditions for RF  
points.  
R# Remote  
Reset  
R# Program  
OK  
R# RF Low Bat  
Res  
Reports low battery  
restoral conditions  
for RF points.  
Yes, No  
* Point text is always transmitted when using  
NetCom applications.  
R# Program  
Fail  
Reports Failed  
Laptop Access  
Event.  
Yes, No  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 23  
User Chng Reports  
Table 19: Access Reports  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Report  
Selections Description  
Table 18: User Change Reports  
R# Access  
Granted  
R# No Entry  
Reports Access  
Granted Event.  
Reports No Entry  
Event.  
Reports Door Left  
Open Event.  
Reports Open Door  
Event.  
Reports Unlock Door  
Event.  
Reports Secure Door  
Event.  
Reports RTE or REX  
Event.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Report  
Selections Description  
R# Date  
Changed  
R# Time  
Changed  
R# Delete  
User*  
R# User Code  
Chg  
Reports Date  
Change Event.  
Reports Time  
Change Event.  
Reports Delete User  
Code Event.  
Reports User  
Passcode Add or  
Change Event.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
R# Door Lt  
Open  
R# Cycle  
Door  
R# Door  
Unlocked  
R# Door  
Secure  
R# Door  
Request  
R# Door  
Locked  
R# Area Watch  
Reports area watch  
start and watch end.  
Reports Card  
Assigned to User  
Event.  
Yes, No  
Yes, No  
Reports Locked Door  
Event.  
R# Card  
Assigned  
2.4  
Enhanced Routing  
R# Change  
Level  
Reports Access  
Control Level  
Change Event.  
Yes, No  
Enhanced routing allows the control panels to  
determine whether events are routed over standard  
telephone lines and/or a local/wide area network  
(LAN/WAN). To send events over a LAN/WAN, a  
D9133TTL-E (SDI-Network Interface Module) is  
required. Additionally, enhanced routing  
* With R# Delete User Events, the control panel  
always uses the account number from Area 1.  
Access Reports  
enables/disables the control panel’s ability to send  
events to a numeric pager. If the installation does  
not require these applications, skip this section.  
Selecting Yes enables a report to be sent when the  
event occurs.  
Access Granted, No Entry, Request to  
Enter (RTE) and Request to Exit (REX)  
Events may be turned on or off by each  
D9210B.  
With enhanced routing, whether you use standard  
telephone lines or the D9133TTL-E, you can select  
full or partial groups of events to be reported to up  
to four different destinations. Routing includes  
choosing the most important destination, whether  
events report to a single or multiple destinations, and  
if the events fail, the backup destination used.  
2.4.1 Programming a Primary and Backup  
Destination  
Each route number has an R# Primary Device and  
an R# Backup Device. With the addition of  
enhanced communications, the R# Primary Device  
destination can be either the phone number or the  
path number IP address to which the route group  
first attempts to send the event. If the R# Primary  
Device destination fails to connect to the central  
station receiver after one or two attempts (see also  
RG# 1 Attempt), the R# Backup Device  
destination is attempted.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 24  
2.4.2 Programming a Duplicate Report  
If you use a D9133TTL-E as a Primary  
Device in any of the route groups, follow  
these programming rules:  
To allow an event within a group to report to  
multiple groups, the event should be Yes for each  
route number available. For instance, programming  
Fire Alarms for Route Group 1 and Route Group 2  
results in the fire alarms first reporting to Route  
Group 1 followed by a duplicate report to Route  
Group 2.  
Assign IP Address 1 as the Primary  
Device in Route Group 1.  
Assign IP Address 2 as the Primary  
Device in Route Group 2.  
Section 2.4 Enhanced Routing determines the route  
groups and which destinations within the route  
groups use D9133TTL-E Modules for reporting  
purposes. A single D9133TTL-E Module can be  
used to transmit events to up to four different  
destinations.  
Assign IP Address 3 as the Primary  
Device in Route Group 3.  
Assign IP Address 4 as the Primary  
Device in Route Group 4.  
The backup device in any route group can  
use any phone number or IP address  
number.  
For example, if you want to send events using Route  
Group 1 over a LAN/WAN as your primary  
destination, and use a standard telephone line as  
your backup destination, you must program the  
following sections:  
1. Routing (see Section 2.3 Routing)  
a. Select Route Group 1  
If the External Modem feature is used,  
RG# Primary SDI and RG# Backup SDI  
must be set to No. The control panel  
supports either enhanced communication  
or external modem, but not both at the  
same time.  
b. Program a 1 for Primary Destination  
c. Program a 1 for Backup Destination  
RG# Primary SDI  
d. Enable all applicable events to be included  
in Route Group 1.  
Phone (see Section 2.1 Phone)  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
a. Select Phone 1.  
Determines if the primary destination for Route  
Group 1 (2, 3, or 4) is sent to the D913TTL-E.  
b. Program Phone 1 with the applicable central  
station receiver phone number.  
Enhanced Routing (see Section 2.4 Enhanced Routing)  
RG# Backup SDI  
a. Enter Yes for Route Group 1 Primary SDI.  
(Tells the control panel to send the events to  
the D9133TTL-E using IP Address 1.)  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
b. Enter No for Route Group 1 Backup SDI.  
(Tells the control panel to use the phone  
line to send events if the primary destination  
fails after one or two attempts.)  
This item determines if the backup destination for  
Route Group 1 (2, 3, or 4) is sent to the D913TTL-E.  
To completely disable Enhanced Routing  
over an SDI path, RG#Primary SDI,  
RG#Backup SDI, and Enhanced Comm  
prompts must all be set to No.  
Because you are using an SDI Path to send events,  
you must also program the applicable items in  
Section 6.5 Enhanced Communications.  
The poll rate entry for the backup SDI path  
might need to increase due to the amount  
of traffic on the network and/or excessive  
signals generated at once. Comm prompts  
must all be set to No.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 25  
Programming the Pager Phone Number  
RG# Primary Pager  
To program the pager phone number, enter the  
number used to reach the pager, followed by pauses.  
Entering C creates a 3-second pause (example:  
5552341CCC.)  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Determines if this route group sends events to a  
numeric pager. To send events to a numeric pager, a  
phone number must also be programmed in the  
route group’s primary destination.  
Experiment with the number of pauses you add after  
the page phone number. Each pause equals 3  
seconds. Try calling the pager yourself first and  
listening to the length of time it takes to get a beep  
allowing you to enter touch-tone information. This  
length is what you must program after the pager’s  
phone number in Section 2.1 Phone. If you need a  
longer pause, enter D after the number. Each D  
equals to 7 seconds.  
0101  
If programming the control panel to dial a  
01  
numeric pager, choose its route group  
carefully. If there are any events to transmit  
to a central station, be sure to place those  
events in a lower numbered route group  
class than the events that are in the route  
group for the numeric pager.  
0101  
Using “#” characters in the phone number can affect  
how the event is displayed on the pager:  
No “#” characters in phone number: Dashes  
appear in the display [1234-001-011-008].  
Numeric Pager Capability  
The D9412G/D7412G Control Panels can transmit  
nearly any event to a numeric pager. Any time an  
event is generated and routed to a numeric pager,  
the control panel attempts to call the numeric pager  
once for each message in the queue. To enable the  
pager, program both the primary and backup phone  
number to the numeric pager’s phone number in  
any of the four route groups. Then select which  
events are to be routed to the numeric pager within  
the route group selected.  
One “#” character in phone number: Dashes  
are replaced by zeros [1234000100110008].  
Two or more “#” characters in phone  
number: Dashes appear in the display [1234-  
001-011-008].  
For example, if the phone number 2773074#CC  
(seven-digit pager phone number followed by “#”  
and two pauses) is programmed, the pager message  
displays as follows: [1234000100110008] (dashes are  
replaced by zeros).  
When events are sent to a numeric pager, up to four  
fields can be displayed in the pager message. See  
Figure 1.  
If the “#” is not placed in the phone number, the  
message displays as follows: [1234-001-011-008]  
Figure 1: Pager Display Fields  
Also, a user may not want all four fields to be  
displayed in the pager message. “*” characters in the  
phone number allow the user to select the number of  
fields to be displayed in the pager message. To limit  
the number of fields shown in the pager message,  
enter the appropriate number of “*” characters in the  
phone number as shown below.  
[1234-001-011-008]  
1
2 3 4  
1 - Account number (1234)  
2 - Event policy (001)  
3 - Event number (011, Fire Alarm Event)  
4 - User number, point number, or relay number  
(008)  
Zero “*” characters in phone number: All  
four fields are displayed.  
One “*” character in phone number: First  
field only is displayed.  
Two “*” characters in phone number: First  
two fields are displayed.  
The account number must contain four  
numeric digits. No alpha characters (B to  
F) are allowed when using the numeric  
pager.  
Three “*” characters in phone number: First  
three fields are displayed.  
Four or more “*” characters in phone  
number: All four fields are displayed.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 26  
For example, the phone number 2773074***CC  
(7 digit pager phone number followed by three  
asterisks and two pauses) produces the following  
pager display: [1234-001-011] (three fields display at  
the pager).  
Table 20: continued  
Event  
Priority  
Event  
Number  
Event Description  
Forced Close Perim Instant  
Forced Close Perim Delay  
Perimeter Instant Armed  
Perimeter Delay Armed  
Send User Text  
Table 20 shows the description of each event, its  
priority, and event number.  
007  
007  
008  
008  
n/a  
084  
085  
088  
089  
n/a  
Table 20: Event Descriptions, Priorities, and  
Numbers  
S: Alarm  
n/a  
n/a  
S: Trouble  
S: Supervision  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
Event  
Priority  
Event  
Number  
Event Description  
Fire Alarm  
Fire Restoral (after Alarm, Supervision)  
Fire Missing  
Status Report  
S: Open  
S: Close  
Test Report  
S: Perimeter Instant  
S: Perimeter Delay  
S: Fire Supervision  
S: Fire Alarm  
008  
n/a  
n/a  
008  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
035  
n/a  
n/a  
051  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
001  
005  
005  
005  
005  
005  
004  
005  
005  
003  
006  
002  
006  
008  
006  
008  
006  
006  
006  
004  
006  
008  
006  
007  
007  
008  
008  
007  
008  
008  
008  
008  
007  
008  
011  
014  
013  
012  
124  
015  
027  
146  
123  
016  
018  
004  
019  
055  
017  
020  
078  
024  
091  
045  
026  
147  
169  
007  
008  
021  
022  
034  
040  
041  
044  
047  
048  
050  
Fire Trouble  
Fire Supervision  
Fire Restoral (after Tbl, Msg, Bypass)  
Fire Cancel  
Fire Supervision Missing  
Fire Supervision Restore  
Alarm Report  
Burg Restore  
Duress  
Missing Alarm  
User Code Tamper  
Trouble Report  
Missing Trouble  
Non-Fire Supervision  
Point Bus Fail  
Point Bus Restoral  
Non-Fire Cancel  
Alarm Restore  
Supervision Missing  
Unverified Event  
Point Bypass/Command Bypass  
Forced Point  
Point Opening  
Point Closing  
Was Force Armed  
Fail To Open  
Fail To Close  
S: Fire Trouble  
S: Missing Fire (Trouble)  
S: Missing Burglary ((Trouble)  
S: Missing Burglary (Alarm)  
S: Fire Supervision Missing  
S: Burglary Supervision Missing  
S: Door Left Open  
SDI Device Failure*  
SDI Device Restoral*  
Watchdog Reset  
Parameter Checksum Fail  
Reboot  
Phone Line Fail  
Phone Line Restoral  
AC Failure  
AC Restoral  
Battery Missing  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
n/a  
004  
008  
004  
n/a  
070  
071  
077  
n/a  
008  
004  
008  
004  
008  
004  
004  
008  
004  
008  
n/a  
007  
007  
007  
007  
007  
008  
008  
008  
082  
068  
069  
072  
073  
074  
075  
076  
066  
067  
n/a  
031  
032  
033  
057  
058  
151  
052  
053  
Battery Low  
Battery Restoral  
Route Comm Fail  
Route Comm Restore  
Checksum Fail  
Sensor Reset  
Relay Set  
Relay Reset  
Sked Executed  
Sked Changed  
Fail to Execute  
Extend Close Time  
Opening Report  
Forced Close  
Closing Report  
Event Log Threshold  
Event Log Overflow  
* SDI Device number is not reported when using pager format.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 27  
2.5  
Power Supervision  
Table 20: continued  
AC Fail Time  
Event  
Priority  
Event  
Number  
Default:  
15  
1 to 90 (Blank and 0 are invalid)  
Event Description  
Parameters Changed  
RAM Access OK  
RAM Access Fail  
Remote Reset  
Program Access OK  
Program Access Fail  
Service Start  
Service End  
Fire Walk Start  
Fire Walk End  
Walk Test Start  
Walk Test End  
Extra Point  
008  
008  
008  
008  
n/a  
054  
064  
065  
079  
n/a  
Selection:  
Program the amount of time that AC power must be  
off before the control panel responds to the AC  
failure. Beginning with version 6.20 and higher,  
changes were made as to how AC Fail Events are  
generated. See the following information to  
determine the available options. The response to  
restoral of AC power is delayed for the same amount  
of time. The control panel always monitors AC.  
n/a  
n/a  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
n/a  
029  
030  
036  
037  
038  
039  
023  
n/a  
When you program AC Fail Time, if the second  
digit is:  
1, 3, 5, 7, or 9 (such as 3, 5, 11, 13, 15, 21, and  
so on): The AC Fail Time interval is in minutes.  
Send Point Text  
RF Low Battery  
RF Battery Restore  
Date Changed  
Time Changed  
Delete User  
User Code Change  
Area Watch  
Card Assigned  
Change Level  
Access Granted  
No Entry  
Door Left Open  
Cycle Door  
Door Unlocked  
Door Secure  
Door Request  
006  
006  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
007  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
008  
002  
002  
093  
094  
059  
060  
090  
056  
042  
110  
061  
003  
115  
116  
112  
113  
114  
117  
145  
005  
006  
2, 4, 6, 8, or 0 (such as 2, 4, 6, 10, 12, 20, 22,  
and so on): The AC Fail Time interval is in  
seconds.  
For the following items to be true, AC Fail/Res Rpt  
must be programmed as Yes and AC Tag Along  
must be programmed as No.  
When you program AC Fail Time, if the second  
digit is:  
1, 3, or 5 (such as 3, 5, 11, 13, 15, 21, and so  
on): The AC Fail Time interval is in minutes  
and an AC Fail Event is transmitted after the  
loss of AC for this amount of time.  
No additional AC Fail Events are transmitted  
after 6 hours or 12 hours.  
Door Locked  
User Alarm COMMAND 7  
User Alarm COMMAND 9  
2, 4, or 6 (such as 2, 4, 6, 12, 14, 16, 22, 24, 26,  
and so on): The AC Fail Time interval is in  
seconds and an AC Fail Event is transmitted  
after the loss of AC for this amount of time.  
No additional AC Fail Events are transmitted  
after 6 or 12 hours.  
7 (such as 7, 17, 27, 37, and so on): The AC  
Fail Time interval is in minutes and an AC Fail  
Event is transmitted after the loss of AC for this  
amount of time.  
An additional AC Fail Event is transmitted after  
6 hours if the AC Fail condition is still present.  
8 (such as 8, 18, 28, 38, and so on): The AC  
Fail Time interval is in seconds and an AC Fail  
Event is transmitted after the loss of AC for this  
amount of time.  
An additional AC Fail Event is transmitted after  
6 hours if the AC Fail condition is still present.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 28  
9 (such as 9, 19, 29, 39, and so on): The AC  
Fail Time interval is in minutes and an AC Fail  
Event is transmitted after the loss of AC for this  
amount of time.  
AC Fail/Res Rpt  
An additional AC Fail Event is transmitted after  
12 hours if the AC Fail condition is still present.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
0 (such as 10, 20, 30, and so on): The AC Fail  
Time interval is in seconds and an AC Fail  
Event is transmitted after the loss of AC for this  
amount of time.  
An additional AC Fail Event is transmitted after  
12 hours if the AC Fail condition is still present.  
Yes  
Send AC Fail and AC Restoral  
Reports.  
No  
Does not send AC Fail and AC  
Restoral Reports.  
AC Power Supervision Reports are sent to the  
central station and local printer at the time  
programmed for AC Fail Time.  
For the following items to be true, AC Fail/Res Rpt  
must be programmed as No and AC Tag Along  
must also be programmed as No.  
0101  
To comply with NFPA standards and UL  
When you program AC Fail Time, if the second  
digit is:  
01  
864 requirements for commercial fire  
systems, program this item as No and  
program AC Tag Along as Yes. AC  
Restoral Reports are not transmitted.  
0101  
1, 3, or 5 (such as 3, 5, 11, 13, 15, 21, and so  
on): The AC Fail Time interval is in minutes.  
No AC Fail or AC Restoral Events are  
transmitted.  
AC Tag Along  
2, 4, or 6 (such as 2, 4, 6, 12, 14, 16, 22, 24, 26,  
and so on): The AC Fail Time interval is in  
seconds. No AC Fail or AC Restoral Events are  
transmitted.  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Send AC messages as tag along events.  
7 (such as 7, 17, 27, 37, and so on): The AC  
Fail Time interval is in minutes. An AC Fail  
Event is only transmitted after 6 hours if the AC  
Fail condition is still present.  
Do not send AC messages as tag along  
events.  
Send AC Reports only if any other event occurs  
while AC is off-normal.  
8 (such as 8, 18, 28, 38, and so on): The AC  
Fail Time interval is in seconds. An AC Fail  
Event is only transmitted after 6 hours if the AC  
Fail condition is still present.  
If AC Tag Along is set to Yes and a  
subsequent event is generated, the AC  
Fail Event is transmitted first, prior to any  
subsequent events transmitting.  
9 (such as 9, 19, 29, 39, and so on): The AC  
Fail Time interval is in minutes. An AC Fail  
Event is only transmitted after 12 hours if the  
AC Fail condition is still present.  
0101  
AC Tag Along is required for NFPA and  
UL 864 commercial fire systems. Be sure  
01  
0101  
to program AC Fail/Res Rpt as No if AC  
Tag Along is programmed Yes.  
0 (such as 10, 20, 30, and so on): The AC Fail  
Time interval is in seconds. An AC Fail Event is  
only transmitted after 12 hours if the AC Fail  
condition is still present.  
Firmware versions 6.20 and higher: To  
eliminate AC Reporting, AC Tag Along  
and AC Fail/Res Rpt must be  
programmed No and the second digit of  
the AC Fail Time must be a 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or  
6.  
Firmware versions 6.10 and lower: To  
eliminate AC Reporting, AC Tag Along  
and AC Fail/Res Rpt must be  
programmed No.  
Bosch Sec
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 29  
2.6  
Printer Parameters  
AC/Battery Buzz  
Up to three D9131A Parallel Printer Interface  
Modules can be connected to the D9412G’s (one  
printer for the D7412G’s) SDI bus. Each printer is  
identified by an address of 17, 18, or 19. Options are  
available for Routing Reports and area assignments.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Initiates panel-wide trouble tone at all  
command centers.  
Printer Address  
No  
Does not initiate panel-wide trouble  
tone at command centers  
Default:  
17  
Initiate a panel-wide trouble tone at command  
centers when AC fails or battery is low or missing.  
This program item does not prevent the SERVC AC  
FAILor SERVC BATT LOWdisplays.  
Selection:  
17, 18, or 19 (only 17 is available for  
the D7412G)  
Enter the printer address you are programming.  
0101  
01  
0101  
P## Area Assign  
To comply with NFPA standards and UL  
864 requirements for commercial fire  
systems, program this item as Yes.  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
De-selecting individual command centers  
for panel-wide trouble tones: Panel-wide  
trouble tones for programming the CC  
Trouble Tone in the command center  
parameters to No can turn off individual  
command centers [based on their CC# (1  
to 8)].  
Assign an area to the printer programmed in Printer  
Address.  
P## Supervised  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Bat Fail/Res Rpt  
Yes  
Only one printer can be installed for  
this P## SDI address.  
Default:  
Yes  
No  
More than one unsupervised printer  
can be installed using this P## SDI  
address using the same address DIP  
switch setting.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes Battery Failure and Restoral Reports are sent  
to the central station. They are routed to the  
telephone number programmed for  
Power/Phone Events.  
Supervise this SDI address and generate Trouble  
SDI ## Reports and local trouble annunciation if a  
problem occurs with this printer or the SDI bus.  
BATTERY  
MISSING  
Modem Missing or  
Reports  
shorted  
Unsupervised printers sharing the same  
address setting print the same text.  
BATTERY LOW  
Discharged  
below 12.1 VDC  
TROUBLE  
ZONE 9  
BFSK  
Reports  
Missing, shorted  
low battery  
Trouble SDI ## Reports are always  
reported as Area 1, Account 1 Events  
regardless of where the SDI device is  
assigned.  
No Battery Failure and Restoral Reports are NOT  
sent to the central station.  
0101  
01  
0101  
To comply with NFPA standards and UL  
864 requirements for commercial fire  
systems, program this item as Yes.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 30  
See the report tables in Section 2.3  
Routing to identify the events that print.  
Events programmed as No in routing still  
print at the local printer. Individual events  
within the report group cannot be  
suppressed for events printed at the local  
printer.  
When P## Supervised is set to Yes and  
all Printer Event Groups (such as P##  
Fire Events, P## Burglar Event, or P##  
Usr Chng Evt) are set to No, the control  
panel does not generate Trouble SDI ##  
Reports for the printer if the D9131A  
becomes disconnected.  
P## Fire Events  
P## Scope  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Default:  
No Printer  
Selection:  
Selection:  
No Printer, Area, Account, Panel  
Wide, Custom  
Yes  
All events in this group print at this  
printer.  
Panel  
Wide  
Printer prints all designated events that  
occur panel-wide. A panel-wide printer  
can cross account boundaries.  
No  
No events in this group print at this  
printer.  
Use this prompt to determine whether these events  
print at this printer.  
Account  
Printer prints all designated events that  
occur within any area with the same  
account number in which this printer is  
assigned.  
P## Burglar Event  
Area  
Printer prints all designated events that  
occur in the area to which this printer  
is assigned.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
P## Access Event  
Custom  
See the following Programming Tip.  
Printer prints all events occurring in  
areas programmed Yes for this prompt  
regardless of any boundary restrictions.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
No Printer No printer installed at this address. If a  
printer is connected, data does not  
print.  
P## User Event  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Press the [SPACE ] bar to scroll through the  
selections. Press [ENTER] when the correct selection  
appears in the display.  
Selection:  
P## Test Event  
0101  
01  
0101  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
The following prompts are visible ONLY  
when you program P## Scope to Custom.  
Selection:  
P## Diag Event  
P## A1 [through A8] in Scope  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Include Area # Events in the scope of  
this printer.  
No  
Does not include Area # Events in the  
scope of this printer.  
Only available if P## Scope is programmed  
Custom. This program item determines whether  
events occurring in an area prints at this printer.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 31  
When RAM programming changes parameters, a  
Parameters Changed Report is sent to the  
D6500/D6600. If any programming changes are  
made, perform a Reset-bye.  
P## Auto Functions Event  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
When RAM attempts to make contact with the  
control panel, the RAM passcode and DataLock  
code are verified. If the control panel passcode  
matches and the DataLock code does not, the  
control panel still generates a RAM Access OK  
Event. However, the session ends immediately.  
P## RAM Event  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
To disable remote programming, enter Blank in  
both Answer Armed and Answer Disarmed  
prompts in this section.  
P## Relay Event  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
2.7.2 Log Threshold Reports  
Selection:  
If communication with RAM is not successful, or if  
no phone number is programmed in RAM Ph, the  
control panel generates Log Threshold and Bad Call  
to Ram. This indicates the log is filling and the  
control panel cannot download its events.  
P## Point Event  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
If there is no RAM Ph programmed, the control  
panel generates the Log Threshold and Bad Call to  
RAM Events immediately. Bad Call to RAM Events  
are currently logged locally only. If there is a RAM  
Ph programmed, the control panel makes multiple  
attempts to reach RAM before sending the reports.  
See the RAM Ph prompt in the following section for  
an explanation of dialing characteristics.  
P## Usr Chng Evt  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
2.7  
RAM Parameters  
Use these program items to enable Remote Account  
Manager (RAM) functions in the control panel using  
the on-board phone connection. Two other methods  
of remote programming are available (external  
modem or LAN/WAN connection) using RAM. See  
Section 6.4 SDI RAM Parameters for further  
2.7.3 RAM Callback Reports  
When dialing the RAM phone number, the control  
panel immediately makes two attempts to reach  
RAM. If the control panel does not reach RAM on  
the first two attempts, it waits 10 minutes then tries  
six more times with a 10-minute interval between  
each attempt. One hour after the last failed attempt,  
the control panel again starts dialing the RAM  
phone number. It immediately makes two more  
attempts then waits 10 minutes and tries six more  
times with 10-minute intervals between each attempt  
before generating a Bad Call to RAM Report and  
abandoning the effort.  
information on these types of remote programming.  
2.7.1 Uploading and Downloading Reports  
If the control panel is programmed to send reports  
in modem format, when RAM makes contact with  
the control panel and the passcode is incorrect, the  
control panel sends a RAM Access Fail Report to  
the D6500/D6600. RAM Access Fail is also  
generated when the call is not terminated with either  
a Good-bye or Reset-bye command.  
Remote Program Dialing Exception: When a  
RAM phone number is programmed, the user can  
call RAM by entering [COMMAND][4][3] and  
pressing the [NEXT] key until CALLRAM?is  
displayed. Press [ENTER]. When performing this  
function, only one attempt is made to contact RAM.  
RAM ACCESS OK is sent according to phone  
routing when a Good-bye command is entered from  
RAM to terminate the call.  
When a Reset-bye is used to terminate the call, a  
Remote Reset Report is sent to the D6500/D6600,  
and a RAM ACCESS OK is placed into the control  
panel’s event log. Reports in the event log that were  
not sent prior to the Reset-bye are never sent to the  
D6500/D6600.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 32  
RAM Passcode  
RAM Call Back  
Default:  
999999  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Selection:  
0 to 9, A to F  
Yes or No  
(six characters required)  
Yes  
When the control panel hears the  
proper RAM passcode, it hangs up the  
phone, seizes the phone line, then dials  
the programmed RAM phone number  
(see the RAM Ph prompt in this  
section). This ensures that the control  
panel only communicates with RAM  
units connected to the programmed  
phone number.  
Enter six characters. Do not use a space in the  
passcode.  
The control panel verifies the Remote Account  
Manager at the central station has valid access  
before connecting using the RAM passcode.  
Log % Full  
Default:  
Blank  
No  
The RAM session is initiated  
Selection:  
1 to 99, or Blank  
immediately. No call back is required.  
The control panel can engage in RAM  
sessions when called from any phone  
number and a proper RAM passcode  
is identified.  
This parameter determines how full the memory log  
should be before initiating a call to RAM at the  
central station. This allows the central station to call  
the control panel and copy the memory log before  
messages are overwritten.  
This function allows the control panel, after it  
verifies the RAM passcode, to provide an additional  
level of security by hanging up and dialing the RAM  
phone number at the central station before allowing  
any upload or download.  
Blank disables the Log Threshold and Log Overflow  
Events. These events are not entered in the log or  
reported to the D6500/D6600 or the local printer.  
The control panel continues to log events after the  
Log Threshold Report is sent. When it reaches 100%  
capacity (memory logger is full and previously  
stored events are overwritten), the control panel  
generates a local Log Overflow Event.  
0101  
When using the RAM Call Back feature,  
01  
be sure to program the character “C” as  
the last digit in the RAM phone number  
when using DTMF Dialing.  
0101  
The control panel does not call RAM again until it  
downloads the log and the Log % Full percentage is  
again reached. These events are also sent to the  
control panel’s event log and to the local printer(s) if  
installed.  
RAM Line Monitor  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
0101  
The Log Overflow Event is not sent to the  
central station unless Expanded Test Rpt  
is programmed Yes.  
Yes  
No  
Allows the control panel to  
communicate with RAM after the  
answering machine answers the phone.  
01  
0101  
Program No if the control panel is not  
sharing the phone line with an  
answering machine.  
This program item enables a control panel, which  
shares a phone line with an answering machine, to  
communicate with RAM at the central station even  
though the answering machine answers the phone.  
You must program Answer Armed and/or Answer  
Disarmed. The control panel must be in the proper  
armed state.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 33  
0101  
Ram Ph  
Program this item No if it causes false  
01  
seizures of the phone line or if you are not  
using RAM (this indicates a device using  
the same frequency tone is also using the  
phone line to which the control panel is  
connected).  
0101  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Up to 24 characters  
Blank  
Control panel does not dial a phone  
number for RAM.  
If RAM Call Back is programmed Yes, the  
control panel hangs up the phone after  
the RAM tone and a proper RAM  
passcode is identified. It then calls the  
RAM phone number.  
This is the phone number the control panel dials to  
contact RAM. The control panel dials the  
programmed number on Phone #5 (RAM Ph #)  
when the following events occur:  
Log % Full threshold is achieved.  
Answer Armed  
If Log % Full was programmed with a  
value (1 to 99) and a RAM phone number  
is programmed, the control panel dials the  
RAM phone number when the log  
threshold is reached. This function is not  
available in RPS. Do not program Log %  
Full and RAM phone number at the same  
time.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection:  
1 to 15, or Blank  
Blank  
No answer.  
1 to 15  
The control panel answers the phone  
after the specified number of rings  
when all areas are master armed.  
The control panel is contacted by RAM and  
RAM Call Back is programmed Yes.  
Set the telephone ring counter to answer when all  
areas are master armed. If any area in the control  
panel is perimeter armed or disarmed, the Answer  
Disarmed ring counter is used.  
COMMAND 43 is initiated and the user selects  
Call RAM option.  
Enter up to 24 characters to define dialing  
characteristics.  
The RAM considers perimeter armed as a  
disarmed state.  
See Phone 1 in Section 2.1 Phone.  
Answer Disarmed  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
1 to 15, or Blank  
Remote Program Dialing Exception:  
When a RAM phone number is  
Selection:  
programmed, the user can call RAM by  
pressing [COMMAND][4][3] then [NEXT]  
until CONTACT RAM?displays, then press  
[ENTER]. At this point, the user can press  
[ENTER] when RAM VIA PHONE?is  
displayed. When performing this function,  
only one attempt is made to contact RAM.  
Blank  
No answer.  
1 to 15  
The control panel answers the phone  
after the specified number of rings  
when any area in the system is in a  
perimeter armed or disarmed state.  
Set telephone ring counter to answer when any area  
is in a perimeter armed or disarmed state.  
The RAM considers perimeter armed as a  
disarmed state.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 34  
A Cancel and Fire Cancel Report is created when a  
passcode is entered to silence an Alarm Bell or a  
Fire Bell before the bell time expires.  
2.8  
Miscellaneous  
Duress Type  
2.9  
Area Parameters  
Default:  
1
This programming module contains three  
programming categories: Area Parameters, Bell  
Parameters, and Open/Close Options.  
Selection:  
1 or 2  
1
Add 1 to the last digit to generate an alarm. For  
example, if the passcode is 6123, 6124 triggers a  
duress alarm.  
2.9.1 Area Parameters  
Area  
If the last digit of the passcode is 0, a duress  
alarm is generated when the user enters 1 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
If the last digit of the passcode is 9, a duress  
alarm is generated when the user enters 0 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
Enter the area number you are programming.  
A# Area On  
2
Add 2 to the last digit to generate an alarm. For  
example, if the passcode is 6123, 6125 triggers a  
duress alarm.  
Default:  
Yes (Area 1 only)  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
If the last digit of the passcode is 8, a duress  
alarm is generated when the user enters 0 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
Yes  
No  
Area is enabled.  
Area is disabled.  
Use this program item to enable or disable the area  
specified.  
If the last digit of the passcode is 9, a duress  
alarm is generated when the user enters 1 as the  
last digit of the passcode.  
0101  
1. When programmed No, points  
01  
assigned to this area do not generate  
0101  
This program item determines whether users add  
one (+1) or two (+2) to the last digit of the passcode.  
To activate a duress alarm, the user increases the  
value of the last digit of their passcode when  
entering it at the command center.  
events.  
Command centers with Area scope  
which are assigned to this area  
display AREA # DISABLED.  
When arming and disarming, this area  
number is not displayed at control  
centers with the scope to view this  
area.  
Duress is enabled/disabled by area in  
Area Parameters.  
Status for this area is not reported  
with Status Reports.  
All user authority in this area is turned  
The duress alarm is activated when a user  
enters the duress combination followed by  
the termination keys ([ESC] or [ENT]).  
off while the area is disabled.  
2. Area 1 must be enabled: System  
events such as power and phone  
supervision do not report properly if  
Area 1 is disabled.  
Cancel Report  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Send Cancel and Fire Cancel Reports  
according to routing.  
No  
Do not send Cancel and Fire Cancel  
Reports.  
Use this program item to control whether or not  
Cancel and Fire Cancel Reports are sent.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 35  
A# Acct Number  
Table 21: Programming Four-Digit Account  
Numbers  
Default:  
0000  
Selection:  
For BFSK: 0000 to 0999,  
0BBB to 0FFF  
D5200 Programmer  
A# Acct# Dgt 1&2 0 0  
A# Acct# Dgt 3&4 0 0  
A# Acct# Dgt 5&6 0 0  
A# Acct# Dgt 7&8 1 2  
A# Acct# Dgt 9&10 3 4  
For Modem (four-digit account  
numbers): 0000 to 9999,  
BBBB to FFFF  
For Modem (ten-digit account  
numbers): 0000000000 to  
9999999999, BBBBBBBBBB to  
FFFFFFFFFF  
The D5200 account number entry shown in Table 21  
appears in RPS as 1234.  
Determines the account number reported for this  
area. An account number must be assigned to each  
active area.  
Although the D5200 allows the character  
“A” to be entered into the account, do  
NOT use this character for the account  
number.  
Account numbers are used to group areas together.  
Each area can have a different account number, or  
several areas may share the same account number.  
The control panel uses the account number as a  
reference for arming and command center text  
displays.  
Any account number digits containing “A”  
for digits 1 to 6 that were uploaded to and  
received by RPS are NOT displayed.  
If an “A” was erroneously sent to the  
control panel from the D5200 for any of  
Digits 1 to 6, this can be corrected by:  
BFSK: Only the last three digits are transmitted.  
Insert a 0 as the first digit of the account number.  
Example: 0 2 3 4.  
Modem IIIa2: Enter a four-digit or ten-digit number.  
Entering six leading 0s from the  
D5200 and sending them to the  
control panel.  
2.9.2 Programming Account Numbers in 9000  
Series Control Panels, versions 6.20 and  
Higher  
Entering six leading 0s from RPS,  
followed by the four-digit account  
number, and sending them to the  
control panel.  
The 9000MAIN version 1.12 handler and version  
6.20 firmware and higher now can program a four-  
digit or ten-digit account number for each area.  
Programming Ten-Digit Account Numbers  
Programming Four-Digit Account Numbers  
To properly program a ten-digit account number  
(such as 1122334455) using the D5200 Programmer,  
you must enter a character for each of the ten digits.  
See Table 22:  
To properly program a four-digit account number  
(such as 1234) using the D5200 Programmer, you  
must enter leading 0s (zeroes) in Digits 1 to 6, and  
then enter 1234 into Digits 7 to 10. When 0s are  
entered for the first six digits (Digits 1 to 6), the 9000  
Series Control Panel treats this as a four-digit  
account number. See Table 21.  
Table 22: Programming Ten Digit Account  
Numbers  
D5200 Programmer  
A# Acct# Dgt 1&2 1 1  
A# Acct# Dgt 3&4 2 2  
A# Acct# Dgt 5&6 3 3  
A# Acct# Dgt 7&8 4 4  
A# Acct# Dgt 9&10 5 5  
The D5200 account number entry shown in Table 22  
appears in RPS as shown in Figure 2.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 36  
Figure 2: Account Number Entry  
A# Delay Res  
Default:  
No  
Yes or No  
1
2
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
Selection:  
3
4
5
6
7
Yes  
No  
Point Restoral Report is not sent until  
the bell time expires or user  
acknowledges alarm condition.  
1 - RPS account number entry  
2 - Corresponding D5200 account number digits  
3 - Digits 1 and 2  
Restoral Reports are sent when point  
restores, regardless of bell time.  
4 - Digits 3 and 4  
5 - Digits 5 and 6  
6 - Digits 7 and 8  
7 - Digits 9 and 10  
A# Exit Tone  
Default:  
Yes  
Yes or No  
Selection:  
Although the D5200 allows the character  
“A” to be entered into the account, do  
NOT use this character for the account  
number.  
Sound an exit tone during exit delay at all command  
centers assigned to this area.  
De-selecting individual command  
centers for exit tones: Exit tones for  
programming the CC Exit Tone as No can  
be turned off for individual command  
centers (based on their CC# 1 through 8).  
Make sure your central station receivers  
(D6500 MPU version 1.06 or D6600 CPU  
version 01.01.04) and your automation  
software are compatible with ten-digit  
account numbers before programming a  
ten-digit account number in a 9000 Series  
control panel.  
A# Exit Dly Time  
Default:  
60  
A# FA Bypass Max  
Selection:  
Blank (0) to 600 ( in 5 second  
increments)  
Default:  
1
Exit delay time for this area when Master Exit or  
Perimeter Exit arming.  
Selection:  
1 to 99  
Specify the maximum number of combined  
Controlled points that can be faulted or bypassed  
when arming this area.  
Points programmed for instant alarms  
generate alarms immediately, even during  
exit delay. To prevent instant alarms on  
points, the user must cause a fault to leave  
the building, program P### Type in the  
Point Index as 3 (Interior Follower).  
See the prompts P## FA Retrnable and P## BA  
Retrnable in Section 4.1.1 Point Responses for  
returning a point to the system when the point  
returns to normal or when the area is disarmed.  
Users can bypass more points than the  
number entered here during the disarmed  
state. It is only when the user attempts to  
Bypass Arm an area (or areas) that this  
restriction is enforced.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Points need Bypassable programmed Yes  
to be bypassed or force armed. Force  
arming does not bypass 24-hour points.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 37  
Points are programmed individually to activate the  
verification feature. See Section 4.1 Point Index. Any  
resettable Fire point can activate alarm verification  
for the area to which it is assigned. Use separate area  
alarm-verification relays.  
A# Auto Watch  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
To enable alarm verification on a point, program  
Point Index, Fire Point, Alarm Verify, and  
Resettable as Yes.  
Yes  
When the area is disarmed, Watch  
Mode turns on automatically.  
No  
When the area is disarmed, Watch  
Mode must be turned on or off  
manually.  
When an Alarm Verification point trips, the control  
panel automatically removes power to all Resettable  
points connected to the area’s Reset Sensors relay.  
The sensor reset removes power to the sensors for  
the amount of time programmed in Verify Time.  
When power is reapplied, a 60-second confirmation  
window begins. If the detector is still in alarm, or  
trips again during the confirmation window, or if a  
different Resettable Verification point in the area  
trips, an alarm is generated.  
0101  
0101  
001  
Controlled points must be programmed  
as P## Watch Point to generate a watch  
tone.  
A# Verify Time  
Default:  
60  
Example: Verify Time is set for 20 seconds. The  
alarm verification cycle starts when the detector  
trips. No report is generated.  
Selection:  
10 to 60 (in 1-second increments)  
Alarm verification is designed for use with smoke  
detectors to reduce the number of false fire alarms.  
When Verify Time is programmed, the control  
panel can double check smoke detector point  
activations before generating alarm signals.  
Immediately after the detector trips, the area’s sensor  
reset relay interrupts power to points connected to it  
for the time in Verify Time.  
When power is restored to the points, the 60-second  
confirmation window is established. If any detector,  
reset during the verification time, trips again during  
the confirmation window, an alarm is generated. If  
no activity occurs during this period, no alarm is  
generated and the verification window ends. If a  
Verification point trips again after the window ends,  
a new verification cycle begins. See Table 23 for an  
example of verify time.  
DO NOT enable the Cross Point feature  
in point indexes designated for Fire points.  
Check with your authority having jurisdiction (AHJ)  
to determine the maximum verification time  
allowed.  
Table 23:Verify Time  
Restart Alarm  
Verification Point  
Trip  
Verify Time/Reset  
Sensors  
Power removed,  
ignore activity  
60 second  
Confirmation  
Generate alarm if  
additional activity  
received.  
Verification Cycle if  
an Alarm Verification  
point trips.  
☛☛☛☛☛☛  
20 Seconds ☛  
Example: Total  
Cycle time 80  
seconds  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 38  
A# Duress Enable  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Enable Duress alarm for this area.  
Disable Duress alarm for this area.  
This entry determines if this area allows duress  
alarms to be generated. See the Duress Type  
prompt in Section 2.8 Miscellaneous for an  
explanation of duress.  
Setting this item to No for a particular area  
and entering a valid duress passcode for  
that area at the command center now  
displays NO AUTHORITY.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 39  
A# Area Type  
Default:  
Regular  
Selection:  
Regular, Master, Associate, or Shared  
Arms or disarms as an independent area.  
Regular  
Master  
Does not allow arming for this area unless all associate areas with the same A# account number are  
master exit delay arming or master armed. CHK AREAdisplays if the associate areas are not armed.  
Exception: RPS allows master areas to be armed without all associate areas being in the armed  
state.  
A master area can be disarmed regardless of the armed state of the other areas in the account.  
Multiple master areas can be programmed in a single account.  
0101  
Programming Tip:  
01  
0101  
CC# Scope affects master arming  
Area: A master area with a CC# Scope Area requires the associate areas  
are independently armed, or master exit delay before the master area can arm.  
Panel Wide/Account Wide: Upon arming the master area, all associate areas  
within the CC# Scope of the master area begins Master Exit Delay Arm. The  
shared areas begin.  
Using the arming sked (S## Function 1) requires that you first use an arming  
sked to arm the master  
sked to arm the associate areas before using an arming  
area. In addition, arming master areas with RAM IV, Keyswitch, or Auto Close  
parameters (see Open/Close Options) is allowed to occur before all associate  
areas are armed.  
Associate  
Allows arming and disarming regardless of the armed state of the other areas with the same A#  
account number. This type of area is used with a master area and is associated by having the same  
account number.  
Command centers assigned to associate areas, when used in conjunction with  
shared areas, should have the CC# Scope programmed to encompass the  
shared area.  
Shared  
Shared areas cannot be armed using a passcode, keyswitch, sub-control, sked, or by RAM. Doing so  
produces a Watchdog Reset.  
The scope of all associate areas must include the shared area(s) in order to view  
faulted points.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 40  
Access Control Readers Assigned to the Shared  
Area  
2.9.3 Shared-Area Characteristics  
Arming a Shared Area  
The shared area momentarily disarms then begins  
the exit delay sequence, allowing a user to walk to  
an associate area and disarm. If the token/card  
reader assigned to the shared area includes any  
associate area in the D## CC# Scope (in the access  
handler), both the associate area and shared area  
disarms when the token/card is presented.  
Requires all associate areas to be armed. As soon as  
the last associate area is armed, the shared area  
begins its arming sequence automatically. Passcode,  
keyswitch, sub-controls, or RAM cannot arm shared  
areas. To display faulted points at associated areas,  
the shared and associate areas must have the same  
account number.  
Closing Reports for Shared Areas  
Disarming a Shared Area  
If Closing Reports for shared areas are required,  
passcodes also need a valid authority level assigned  
in the shared area.  
Shared areas automatically disarm when any  
associate area in the control panel is disarmed.  
Passcode, tokens/cards, keyswitch, sub-controls, or  
RAM cannot disarm shared areas.  
2.9.4 Bell Parameters  
The D9412G/D7412G have two main types of  
annunciation: Fire Bell and Burg Bell. Both Fire and  
Burg Bells share the same terminal (Terminal 6) on  
the control panel as shipped from the factory.  
Shared Area Arming Sequence  
When shared areas automatically begin to arm, the  
arming is based on the A# Exit Dly Time  
programmed for the area number where the  
command center was assigned.  
In the event of a simultaneous Fire Bell and Burg  
Bell occurrence, the Fire Bell takes precedence over  
the Burg Bell regardless of which relay or terminal  
output they share.  
Shared Area Not Ready  
If a point is faulted in the shared area, CHK AREA  
displays on the associate command center that is  
arming the last associate area. Associate area  
command centers can display faults from shared  
areas as long as the shared areas fall within the scope  
of the associate area.  
When the Fire and Burg Bells share the same output  
and a Fire Bell occurs while the Burg Bell is ringing,  
the Fire Bell pattern overrides the Burg Bell pattern.  
At the end of the fire time, the burg pattern resumes.  
When the Fire and Burg Bells share the same output  
and a Burg Bell occurs while a Fire Bell is sounding,  
the control panel waits until the Fire time expires  
before starting the Burg Bell.  
Force Arming a Shared Area  
When CHK AREAis displayed, pressing [ESC]  
displays FORCE ARMat the associate command  
center. Pressing [ENTER] force arms the shared area  
if the user has authority to bypass points, the point is  
bypassable, AND the number of faulted points does  
not exceed the force arm max amount for the shared  
area. Remember to include the shared area in the  
associate area’s scope.  
Either a single bell (panel-wide) or a number of bells  
(area) can be used on the control panel. For  
programming these applications, see Section 2.13.1  
Area Relays.  
When both Fire and Burg Bells occur simultaneously  
and a user enters a valid passcode, a Fire Cancel  
Report for the fire alarm and a Cancel Report for  
the burg alarm reports to the central station if  
Cancel Reports is programmed Yes.  
Viewing Shared Area Armed Status  
View Area Status can be used from a command  
center outside of the shared area to view the shared  
area’s armed state.  
Area  
Silencing Sounders in the Shared Area  
Shared area alarms and troubles can be silenced  
from any command center.  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
To silence sounders, the user needs an authority  
level assigned to the shared area. If the user also has  
the authority to arm/disarm the area, then ALREADY  
ARMEDor ALREADY DISARMEDmomentarily  
displays.  
Enter the area number you are programming.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 41  
A# Fire Time  
A# Burg Time  
Default:  
9
Default:  
6
Selection:  
1 minute to 90 minutes  
Selection:  
1 minute to 90 minutes (in 1 minute  
increments)  
Enter the number of minutes the bell rings for Fire  
Alarm points. The relay activated for this time is  
programmed in A# Fire Bell in Area Relays.  
Enter the number of minutes the bell rings for  
Burglary Alarm points. The relay activated for this  
time is programmed in A# Alarm Bell in Area  
Relays.  
The bell output begins as soon as the fire alarm  
occurs. It shuts off the bell when the programmed  
number of minutes expires.  
The bell output begins as soon as the burglary alarm  
occurs. It shuts off the bell when the programmed  
number of minutes expires.  
If programmed for 1 minute, the output may be  
anywhere from 0 to 60 seconds of bell time.  
Program Fire Time for 2 minutes or more to ensure  
you have ample output time.  
When the control panel’s internal clock begins a  
new minute, it considers the first minute expired.  
Program Burg Time for 2 minutes or more.  
Check with your AHJ to determine the  
appropriate bell time for your geographical  
area.  
Check with your AHJ to determine the  
appropriate bell time for your geographical  
area.  
A# Fire Pat  
Default:  
Pulse  
A# Burg Pat  
Selection:  
Steady, Pulse, CaStnd, TmCod3  
Steady Output  
Default:  
Steady  
Steady  
Pulse  
Selection:  
Steady, Pulse, CaStnd, TmCod3  
Pulse March Time  
Select the bell pattern this area uses to signal an  
alarm on a Non-fire point.  
120 beats per minute, at an even  
tempo  
Press the [SPACE] bar to scroll through the  
selections. Press [ENTER] when the correct selection  
appears in the display.  
CaStnd  
California Standard  
10 seconds audible + 5 seconds silent  
+ 10 seconds audible + 5 seconds  
silent. This sequence repeats until bell  
time expires.  
A# Single Ring  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
TmCod3  
Temporal Code 3  
Yes  
One bell output per arming period.  
After one alarm, alarms on any Non-  
fire points in the same area cannot  
restart the bell until the armed state  
changes. An alarm on a different point  
in same area restarts bell output.  
0.5 seconds On, 0.5 seconds Off, 0.5  
seconds On, 0.5 seconds Off, 0.5  
seconds On, 1.5 seconds Off; pattern  
repeats. This sequence repeats for a  
minimum of 3 minutes and with a  
10% tolerance.  
Select the bell pattern this area uses to signal an  
alarm on a Fire point.  
No  
Restart bell output with each alarm  
event.  
Press the [Space] bar to scroll through the selections.  
Press [Enter] when the correct selection appears in  
the display.  
Determines if an alarm from a Non-fire point can  
restart the alarm bell time with each Alarm Event, or  
only initiate alarm output once per arming period.  
This does not silence the command center alarm bell  
tone, or prevent any reports. This feature does not  
affect Fire points. Fire points restart bell time with  
each new alarm.  
When two Fire points sharing the same  
relay go into alarm, the bell pattern of the  
most recent fire event takes precedence.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 42  
2.9.5 Open/Close Options  
Programming determines if Opening, All Normal  
Closing, and Force Arm/Bypass Closing Events are  
reported to the remote central station. Without  
remote reporting, all control panel and area arming  
(Closing Events) and disarming (Opening Events)  
default to local events.  
If a 24-hour point alarms while the area is  
disarmed, arming that area with a  
keyswitch does not clear the A# Single  
Ring flag.  
Silencing the bell resets A# Single Ring.  
Use this programming category to determine which  
opening and closing supervision characteristics are  
required.  
A# Bell Test  
There are three ways to generate reports from the  
control panel. You can generate reports by account,  
by area, or a combination of both.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
To suppress reports:  
Yes  
No  
Initiate Bell Test.  
Do not initiate Bell Test.  
Use Opening/Closing Windows to suppress  
reports for a specified period of time and then  
automatically turn them on again.  
Provide alarm output from the relay programmed at  
A# Alarm Bell after the Closing Report was  
confirmed or the exit delay time expired.  
Use the Restricted O/C options. A Closing  
Report is sent if the user is force arming, sending  
duress, or bypass arming. An Opening Report is  
sent if the user is disarming during an alarm  
condition or unbypasses points when disarming.  
If the system is normal, no Opening or Closing  
Report is sent.  
Bell Test After Confirmation  
In areas that report opening and closing activity, the  
Bell Test happens after the control panel sends the  
Closing Report and receives the acknowledgment  
from the central station receiver. For proper  
operation of the Bell Test after closing confirmation,  
the following rules apply:  
For the scheduled suppression of Opening  
and Closing Reports, see Section 5.1.1  
Opening and Closing) to define Opening  
and Closing Windows.  
The control panel must report opening and  
closings to the central station.  
Account Opening and Closing Reports  
Restricted openings and closings should not be  
used, and Opening and Closing Windows  
should not be used.  
Opening and Closing Reports are sent by account  
when the last area in a group of areas with the same  
account number(s) is armed.  
Area Armed Confirmation  
Area Opening and Closing Reports  
In areas that do NOT report opening and closing  
activity, the alarm bell relay output for this area is  
activated for 2 seconds after exit time expires.  
Closing Reports are sent for each area as it is armed.  
The account number is also sent for each area.  
Customizing Account Opening and Closing  
Reports  
Multiple Bell Tests occur: When more than  
one area is armed at the same time (such as  
using the ARM ALL AREAS? function), the  
bell rings for 2 seconds with a 2 second  
pause between each bell activation if all  
areas have the same exit delay time  
programmed. Otherwise, the Bell Test  
occurs as each area arms and it completes  
its exit delay time.  
You can eliminate area Opening and Closing  
Reports from selected areas in the account by  
programming A# Area O/C No for those areas.  
When areas arm simultaneously and report  
to the central station, the Bell Test occurs  
as the central station receiver confirms each  
area.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 43  
Combination Account and Area Opening and  
Closing Reports  
A# Acct O/C  
Default:  
No  
Yes or No  
To send both account openings and closings, and  
individual area openings and closings for all areas in  
the account, you must:  
Selection:  
Yes Send Opening and Closing Reports by  
account.  
Program A# Acct O/C Yes for all areas in the  
account.  
Use this selection if the control panel sends  
reports to an automation system that cannot  
interpret multiple Area Opening/Closing  
Reports, or if Modem Format is programmed  
No in the Phone category (BFSK format is in  
use and Opening and Closing Reports are  
enabled).  
Program A# Area O/C Yes for all areas in the  
account.  
Closing Reports: When areas in the account are  
independently armed, each area generates an Area  
Closing Report. When the last area is armed, it also  
generates an Account Closing Report.  
Opening Reports: When the first area in the  
account is disarmed, it generates an Account  
Opening Report along with an Area Opening  
Report. When the remaining areas in the account  
are disarmed, each area generates an Area Opening  
Report.  
An Account Opening Report is generated  
when the first area in an account is opened  
(disarmed). After the Account Opening Report  
is sent, disarming other areas in the account  
does not generate another Account Opening  
Report. An Account Closing Report is  
generated only when the last area in an  
account is closed (armed). Opening and  
Closing Reports for accounts do not contain  
any area information.  
Area Only Opening/Closing Supervision Features  
Use these features to supervise opening and closing  
activity by area. Auto Close, Fail To Open, and Fail  
To Close all work independently of the A# Acct  
O/C feature. To use these features, you must  
program O/C Windows.  
Opening and Closing Windows affect  
Account Opening and Closing Reports: If  
an account opening or closing is generated  
while an Opening or Closing Window for this  
area is in effect, and Disable O/C in Window  
is programmed Yes, the report is not sent. All  
areas sharing the same account number should  
use the same Opening and Closing Window  
times.  
Area  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
Enter the area number you are programming.  
No Do not send Opening and Closing Reports by  
account.  
Determines if this area generates Account Opening  
and Closing Reports. Program this item the same for  
all areas in the account.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 44  
Determines if opening and closing activity is  
reported when it occurs inside an Opening or  
A# Area O/C  
Closing Window as programmed in O/C Windows.  
Default:  
Yes  
Reports are always logged and printed on a local  
printer, if installed.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes Include the Area # and generate Opening and  
Closing Reports for this area when it is armed.  
A# Auto Close  
Default:  
No  
No Do not include the Area # or generate  
Opening and Closing Reports for this area.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Determines if the area number and the account  
number are reported upon arming and disarming.  
As long as Account O/C is No, the account number  
reports when arming this area individually. If  
Account O/C is Yes, all areas with the same  
account number must also be armed.  
Yes The area automatically master arms at the end  
of the Close Window.  
When the area is armed automatically, a  
Closing Report is sent if Area and/or Account  
Reports are programmed to do so.  
An Area Opening Report is generated when each  
area is opened (disarmed). An Area Closing Report  
is generated when each individual area is closed  
(armed).  
No Do not automatically arm the area at the end  
of the Close Window.  
With this program item, the control panel can  
automatically master arm the area at the end of the  
Closing Window regardless of the previous armed  
state.  
Do not program this item as Yes if the  
control panel reports to an automation  
system that cannot interpret multiple Area  
Opening/Closing Reports.  
Regardless of A# Force Arm Max or P##  
Bypassable, an unconditional force arm  
occurs resulting in faulted points being left  
out of the system until they return to  
normal.  
A# Disable O/C in Window  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
A# Fail to Open  
Yes Do not send Opening and Closing Reports to  
the central station if they occur inside an  
active window.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
If an Opening or Closing Report occurs  
outside a window, send it with an early or late  
modifier. See Section 5.1.1 Opening and Closing.  
Yes Fail to Open Report occurs for this area if the  
area was not disarmed when the Opening  
Window stop time occurred.  
The active window must be a Closing  
Window for Closing Reports. It must be an  
Opening Window for Opening Reports.  
No Fail to Open Report is not sent for this area.  
Use to determine if a Fail to Open Report is sent for  
this area. This can determine if a user failed to  
disarm the area prior to the Opening Window  
expiring. Normal Opening and Closing Reports do  
not need to be programmed to use this feature.  
No Send Opening and Closing Reports to the  
central station even when they occur inside a  
programmed window. If an opening or closing  
occurs outside of the appropriate window, it  
reports but does NOT have an early or late  
modifier.  
If you want to monitor all opening and closing  
activity, but you also want to use features  
provided by Opening and Closing Windows,  
program this item No, and program  
appropriate O/C Windows.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 45  
A# Fail to Close  
A# Restrictd O/C  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes or No  
Yes Fail to Close Report occurs for this area if the  
area was not armed when the Closing  
Window stop time occurred.  
Yes Restrict Opening and Closing Reports for this  
area. A# Area O/C must be programmed  
Yes to generate Restricted Opening and  
Closing Reports.  
Note:  
Note:  
An exit delay time must be programmed in Exit  
Dly Time.  
If a passcode is not required for arming or  
disarming and this item is Yes, the area only  
sends Restricted Opening and Closing Reports.  
In this case, Restricted Reports are sent without  
User ID.  
No Fail to Close Report is not sent for this area.  
Note:  
If Auto Close is programmed Yes, a Fail to  
Close Report is sent because it occurs when the  
Closing Window stop time occurred.  
Opening/Closing Window does not affect this  
report. Windows do not prevent Restricted  
Opening and Closing Reports from being  
sent. Early or late designations are NOT  
added to Opening/Closing Reports when they  
are sent according to the rules for Restricted  
Opening/Closing Reports.  
If Disable O/C in Window is Yes, the Fail  
to Close Report is followed by Closing Late or  
F(orce) Close Late.  
Determines if a Fail to Close Report is sent for this  
area. Use to determine if a user failed to arm the  
area before the Closing Window expires. Normal  
Opening and Closing Reports do not need to be  
programmed to use this feature.  
No Do not Restrict Opening and Closing Reports  
for this area.  
Regardless of programming in Authority  
Levels L## Restricted O/C, reports are not  
restricted in this area when this item is  
programmed No.  
Note:  
Was Force Armed and Forced Close Events can  
still be sent to the central station if enabled in  
Routing when force arming the system.  
This item determines if this area can restrict  
Opening and Closing Report activity.  
A Restricted Opening Report refers to the control  
panel sending an Area Opening Report only when  
the area is disarmed after a non-fire alarm.  
A Restricted Closing Report refers to the control  
panel sending an Area Closing Report only when  
the area was master armed with Controlled points  
that were faulted during the arming sequence. The  
sequence of reports generated by a restricted closing  
is: Was Force Armed, Forced Point, Forced Close,  
and Closing Report.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 46  
2.10 Command Center  
A# Perimeter O/C  
This programming module contains three  
programming categories: Cmd Cntr Assignment,  
Area Text, and Custom Function.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
2.10.1 Cmd Cntr (Command Center) Assignment  
Yes This area can send Perimeter Opening and  
Closing Reports.  
This programming category assigns a command  
center to an area and determines if the command  
center is supervised. The command centers are  
connected to the control panel using a two-wire  
serial data interface bus (SDI bus). This bus can  
support up to eight supervised command centers,  
each with its own unique command center address  
(CC) and corresponding DIP switch address settings.  
Should the command centers not be supervised, you  
can install multiple command centers with the same  
DIP switch address setting for up to 32 unsupervised  
command centers.  
No This area cannot send Perimeter Opening and  
Closing Reports.  
This item determines if this area can send Perimeter  
Instant and Perimeter Delay Closing Reports and  
normal Opening Reports to the central station.  
Opening/Closing Windows do not suppress this  
event.  
Modem format reporting is required. Some  
central station automation systems cannot  
process these reports.  
Cmd Center  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
DIP Switch Setting  
SDI  
Address  
CC# Number  
1
2
3
4
5
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
Enter the command center (CC) number for the SDI address you are programming. This number corresponds to  
the DIP switch address settings shown.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 47  
CC# Supervised  
CC# Scope  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Yes or No  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Panel Wide, Custom, No Keypad,  
Area, and Account  
Yes Only one command center can be installed for  
this CC SDI address.  
Panel  
Wide  
A panel-wide command center can  
view information and perform Arming  
and Disarming functions for all areas in  
the control panel. A panel-wide  
command center can cross account  
boundaries. This is normally used with  
a master area.  
No More than one command center can be  
installed using this CC SDI address with the  
same address DIP switch setting.  
Supervise this SDI address and generate Trouble  
SDI Reports and local trouble annunciation if a  
problem occurs with this command center or the  
SDI bus.  
Account  
An Account command center can view  
information, and perform Arming and  
Disarming functions for all areas with  
the same A# Acct Number, in Area  
Parameters. This is normally used for  
an associate area.  
Command centers sharing the same  
address setting display the same text and  
emit the same tones regardless of which  
command center keys are pressed.  
Trouble SDI # Reports are always  
reported as Area 1, Account 1 Events  
regardless of the area the SDI device is  
assigned.  
Area  
An Area command center is restricted  
to viewing information and  
Arming/Disarming functions for the  
area to which it is assigned.  
Custom  
A Custom command center has no  
command center restrictions.  
0101  
01  
When this prompt is Yes, you cannot have  
duplicate DIP switch settings.  
0101  
No  
Keypad  
No command center installed at this  
address. CALL FOR SERVICE  
displays, indicating the control panel is  
not polling this address.  
0101  
When a D1260 Alpha V Command Center  
01  
is assigned to a command center address,  
you must program CC# Supervised as  
Yes.  
0101  
This program item is used to define the areas  
affected when this command center is armed, the  
areas this command center can view, and the areas  
this command center can move to.  
CC# Area Assign  
Press the [SPACE] bar to scroll through the  
selections. Press [ENTER] when the correct selection  
appears in the display.  
Default:  
1
Selection:  
1 to 8  
Blank is not a valid entry.  
In applications where command centers  
include the scope of more than one area,  
active alarms in remote areas must be  
acknowledged prior to arming or disarming  
the local area.  
Enter the area number where you are installing this  
command center or command centers with this  
address and the same DIP switch settings.  
The following prompts are visible ONLY  
when you program CC## Scope to  
Custom. If the scope was previously  
programmed to be other than No Keypad,  
default settings based on the previous  
scope appear. Prior to exiting a custom  
program, check each area and ensure it is  
properly enabled and disabled.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 48  
CC# A1[through A8] in Scope  
CC# Entr Cycl Dr  
Default:  
See preceding important note  
Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
Include this area in the scope of this  
command center.  
Yes  
No  
The [ENTER] key is used to cycle the  
door programmed for CC Assign  
Door.  
No  
Do not include this area in the scope of  
this command center.  
The [ENTER] key is not used to cycle  
the door.  
Determines whether any of the eight areas (Area 1 to  
Area 8) and Doors (Door 1 to Door 8) are included  
in the scope of this command center for viewing  
status, arming or disarming, and controlling doors  
from the command center.  
Enter Key Cycle Door: Program this prompt as  
Yes to initiate the door cycle sequence (this includes  
shunting the point assigned to the door) for the door  
number programmed in CC Assign Door when a  
user enters a valid passcode and presses [ENTER].  
ACCESS GRANTEDprints on the local printer and at  
the central station receiver, if programmed.  
CC# Entr Key Rly  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
1 to 128, A, B, C, and Blank  
The service passcode cannot be used for  
the CC# Entr Cycl Dr application.  
Blank  
The [ENTER] key is not used to cycle  
a relay.  
1 to 128,  
A, B, C  
Assign the relay number that activates  
when [ENTER] is pressed at this  
command center after the user enters a  
valid passcode.  
When programmed to activate a relay, the  
[ENTER] key cannot be used for any other  
function.  
Relays used for this function must not be  
shared with any other point, sensor reset,  
control panel or bell functions. This can  
cause erroneous relay operation.  
Enter Key Relay: Program the relay number that  
momentarily activates for 10 seconds when a user  
enters a valid passcode and presses the [ENTER]  
key on the command center. Two events are  
generated when this function is used: RELAY ###  
SET with User ID, and RELAY ### RESET  
without User ID.  
0101  
1. The door does not cycle if Entr Key  
01  
Rly is programmed.  
0101  
2. 9210 NOT READYappears at this  
command center when you press  
[ENTER] if the D9210B is not  
programmed with a D# Entry Area (in  
the RADAXS handler) or if CC Assign  
Door does not have a door number  
assigned.  
When programmed to activate a relay, the  
[ENTER] key cannot be used for any other  
function.  
Relays used for this function must not be  
shared with any other point, sensor reset,  
control panel, or bell functions. This can  
cause erroneous relay operation.  
1. Entering a valid code and pressing  
[ENTER] silences a bell if one is  
ringing.  
2. Use this function for a low-level  
access control strike on a door. This  
does not shunt a point.  
3. This action is logged as two events,  
Relay Set and Relay Reset.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 49  
Determines whether this command center, or any  
command center with the same address setting,  
emits the panel-wide trouble tones (power, phone,  
SDI bus, and Zonex bus).  
CC# Assign Door  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
1 to 8, Blank  
Panel-wide trouble tones do not include  
Point Troubles, Buzz on Fault, or Close  
Door Now.  
Blank No door controller is assigned for adding  
tokens or the CLOSE DOOR #displays on  
the command center.  
1 to 8 Assign the door controller that enters the  
Add User Mode when initiated. This door  
activates the CLOSE DOOR #displays at  
this command center if CC Close Door is  
Yes.  
Assign two CCs to the same area so one  
command center emits the tone and  
another does not.  
CC# Entry Tone  
Program the door number used by this command  
center for adding tokens/cards and displaying CC  
Close Door.  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
0101  
1. IMPORTANT! 9210 NOT READY  
Yes  
This command center sounds entry  
tones.  
01  
appears at this command center when  
you attempt to add a user if a door is  
not programmed for this prompt and a  
door is not assigned to the area using  
the D# Entry Area in the RADAXS  
handler. This indicates the control  
panel cannot initiate the Add User  
Mode until a door is assigned to this  
command center.  
0101  
No  
This command center does not sound  
entry tones.  
Determines whether this command center, or any  
command center with the same address setting,  
emits the Disarm Now entry delay tone. Any Delay  
point within the area scope of this command center  
initiates the entry sequence.  
2. A door does not need to be assigned  
to a command center for the user to  
control the door(s) using the Door  
Control function. Any door that is  
active can be controlled by a user who  
has the door control authority enabled  
at a command center with the doors  
area, assigned in the access handler,  
within its scope.  
0101  
This prompt allows you to manage the  
01  
tone by command center. Entry Tone can  
also be turned off when programming your  
P## Entry Tone off in Point Index.  
0101  
Assign two CCs to the same area so one  
command center emits the tone and  
another does not.  
CC# Exit Tone  
During the Add User Mode, token/cards,  
door control requests, and RTE/REX does  
not function. Put the Door Mode into an  
UNLOCKED state before adding users if  
there is heavy activity for this door.  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Yes  
This command center sounds entry  
tones.  
CC# Trouble Tone  
No  
This command center does not sound  
entry tones.  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Determine whether this command center or any  
command center with the same address setting,  
emits the Exit Now ### exit delay tone during the  
delay arming of an area(s). Any command center  
with a scope to arm this area can initiate the exit  
tone sequence.  
Yes  
No  
Panel-wide trouble tones sound and  
visual displays show at this command  
center.  
Panel-wide troubles do not sound.  
Visual displays still show.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 50  
When a D1260 Alpha V Command Center is  
installed at this command center address, this item  
must be set to Yes. This instructs the control panel to  
send additional information to the D1260 required  
for proper operation.  
0101  
01  
This prompt allows you to manage the  
tone by command center. Exit Tone can  
also be turned off when programming A#  
Exit Tone in Area Parameters.  
0101  
0101  
Remember to program CC# Supervised  
Assign two CCs to the same area so one  
command center emits the tone and  
another does not.  
01  
to Yes if a D1260 Alpha V Command  
Center is installed at this address. Failure  
to follow this programming requirement  
results in improper operation of the  
D1260.  
0101  
CC# Arm Now Warn  
Default:  
No  
2.10.2 Area Text  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Use this programming category to create custom  
Idle Text displays for the command centers.  
Yes  
This command center activates a tone  
and displays PLEASE CLOSE NOW.  
Each display can be programmed with up  
to sixteen alphanumeric characters,  
including: A to Z, 0 to 9, ?, &, @, -, *, +,  
$, #, _, /.  
No  
This command center does not activate  
the tone or display PLEASE CLOSE  
NOW.  
Characters not listed are invalid and  
cannot be used for text.  
Determines whether this command center sounds an  
audible tone and displays the PLEASE CLOSE NOW  
warning on the command center when a Closing  
Window activates, indicating the area automatically  
arms soon.  
Area  
Default:  
1
CC# Close Door  
Selection:  
1 to 8  
Default:  
No  
Enter the area number you are programming.  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Area# Is On  
Yes  
This command center sounds a tone  
and displays CLOSE DOOR #.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection:  
No  
This command center does not sound  
the tone or activate the display.  
Enter the text for this area that displays when the  
area is master armed or master instant armed and  
other areas sharing the same account number are  
not yet master armed. This display does not appear  
when the area is perimeter armed.  
Determines whether this command center sounds an  
audible tone and displays the CLOSE DOOR #  
warning on the command center. This occurs when  
the door is physically held open past the shunt time  
and the extend time has a value greater than zero  
(see the Access Program Entry Guide) for the door  
assigned to this area in CC# Assign Door.  
Area # Not Ready  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection:  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
CC# EnhancCmdCtr  
Enter the text for this area that displays when the  
area is disarmed but points are faulted.  
Default:  
No  
Selection:  
Yes or No  
Area # Is Off  
Yes  
This command center is a D1260  
Alpha V Command Center.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
No  
This command center is not a D1260  
Alpha V Command Center.  
Selection:  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Enter the text for this area that displays when the  
area is disarmed and no points are faulted.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 51  
2.10.3 Custom Function  
Area # Acct Is On  
Custom functions are a way to simplify use of  
complex keystroke sequences entered at the  
command center. These items are similar to speed  
dialing on a telephone. A custom function can  
automatically initiate an end user request by pressing  
[ENTER] once the custom function text is displayed  
on the command center. You can have up to sixteen  
custom functions and restrict the use of these by area  
and authority level.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection:  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Enter the text that displays when all areas sharing  
the same account number are master armed. The  
ACCT IS ONtext appears at all command centers  
assigned to these areas, if more than one area has the  
same account number. The ACCT IS ONtext also  
appears if only one area in the system is used. See  
the prompts CC# Area Assign and Area # Acct Is  
On in Section 2.10.1 Cmd Cntr (Command Center)  
Assignment. When all areas in the account are master  
armed, the Area # Is Ontext is replaced by the  
ACCT IS ONtext if the area is armed before all the  
areas with the same account number.  
Each Custom Function ### item has sixteen  
characters of programmable text (CF### Text).  
When the Custom Function is assigned to the menu  
M## Function (see Section 2.12 Function List) the  
user can press [PREV] or [NEXT] to scroll to  
CF### Text. The user accesses the menu by  
pressing [MENU] on the command center.  
0101  
A blank entry disables the ACCT IS ON  
The user needs the appropriate authority level  
enabled for the L## C Function 128 to 143 in  
Section 2.11 User Interface, to use the custom function.  
01  
display for this area, allowing an account  
wide area to display the AREA # IS ON  
text instead of the ACCT IS ONtext.  
0101  
Consider the scope of the command center used to  
access the Custom Function. Each Custom Function  
is enabled in the function menu by M# CC Address  
1 [through 8]. If the Custom Function is not  
assigned to a specific command center address, it  
does not appear in the menu.  
Each area can have unique ACCT IS ON  
text, or you can program the same text in  
each area of the account so when all the  
areas in the account are armed, they all  
show the same text.  
Custom Function  
0101  
0101  
001  
Although it is not programmed in this area,  
the new D1260 Alpha V Command Center  
can display up to sixteen characters for an  
Area Name on line 1 of its display. The  
Area Text (Area # Is Off, Area # Not  
Ready, Area # Is On, and Acct # Is On)  
programmed in this module appears on line  
2 of the D1260 Alpha V Command Center.  
When programming custom text, it should  
be logical to users viewing it on the  
D1260. For example, the Area Name Text  
can be programmed to display Front  
Officeand the Area # Is Off text  
(programmed in this section) could be  
programmed to display Ready To Arm.  
The D1260 would then show on line 1  
Front Officeand on line 2, Ready To  
Arm.  
Default:  
128  
Selection:  
128 to 143  
Enter the Custom Function number you want to  
program. You can program up to sixteen Custom  
Functions, which are numbered 128 to 143.  
CF### Text  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection:  
Sixteen alphanumeric characters.  
See Section 2.10.2 Area Text for  
valid character entries.  
Determines the menu text displayed at the  
command center for the custom function item. Use  
this text to represent the functions performed by this  
menu item.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 52  
CF### Key Strokes  
Table 24: CF### Custom Function Keystrokes  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Command  
Keystroke  
A19  
A29  
A39  
A69  
A79  
A89  
A99  
A09  
Selection:  
Up to 32 characters: 0 to 9, A, B, C,  
D, and E  
1 (Master arm area)  
2 (Perimeter instant arm)  
3 (Perimeter delay arm)  
6 (Watch Mode)  
7 (Special alert)  
8 (Perimeter partial arm)  
9 ( Special alert)  
Selection  
Key  
Faceplate Label  
0 to 9  
A
0 to 9  
[COMMAND]  
[PREV] (previous)  
[ESC] (escape)  
[NEXT]  
B
0 (Bypass a point)  
C
MENU  
D
128 to 143 Enable Custom Function 128  
through 143, (Menu Function only): This  
function determines if a passcode is required  
when attempting to access a Custom Function  
from the menu list. ENTER PASSCODE(or  
Enter Passcode + Enter Keyon the  
D1260) displays when this function is passcode  
protected.  
E
[ENT] (enter)  
YES  
The keystrokes simulate any sequence of keystrokes  
the user can perform at a command center. You can  
program up to 32 keystrokes for each Custom  
Function.  
0101  
D5200 Data Entry: Use the D5200 []  
01  
key to move the cursor to the first data  
entry line. When you want to enter more  
than sixteen keystrokes, the first line of the  
data entry line must be filled before you  
move on to the second line. If you make  
entries on the second line, and the first line  
has less than sixteen characters, the  
second line clears when you press  
[ENTER].  
0101  
0101  
01  
0101  
If a command within the Custom Function  
is passcode protected, the command  
center displays ENTER PASSCODEand  
waits for the user to enter a valid  
passcode before proceeding with the rest  
of the Custom Function. If a passcode is  
not entered within 10 seconds, the  
Custom Function times out and the display  
returns to idle text.  
0101  
01  
0101  
0101  
0101  
001  
The scope of the command center where  
the Function List is accessed can affect  
the way the Custom Function operates.  
Skeds cannot execute Custom Functions  
that are passcode protected. D720 LED  
command center does not support  
Custom Functions that are passcode  
protected.  
Programming Custom Function Keystrokes  
First, find the command you want to execute in  
the User Interface section of the Program Record  
Sheet.  
Some functions cannot be entered directly  
because they are nested inside a higher-level  
function. To automatically execute these  
functions, you must add the appropriate  
keystrokes.  
Single digit commands must be programmed  
with 9 as the second digit.  
For example: In the Change Display  
(COMMAND 49) function there are three sub-  
functions: Bright Display, Dim Display, and  
Date/Time Display.  
-
To turn up the display, enter:  
[A][4][9][E]  
-
-
To dim the display, enter:  
[A][4][9][D][E]  
To display time and date, enter:  
[A][4][9][B][E]  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 53  
The D9412G/D7412G Program Record Sheet lists the  
commands available with the system. Command  
numbers are shown in the column labeled  
Command. If a particular function does not have a  
command number, it can only be accessed through  
the Function List.  
Custom Functions can perform several tasks at  
once. For example:  
-
To toggle relays 7, 8, and 9 in one Custom  
Function enter:  
[A] [5] [4] [7] [E] [E] [8] [E] [E] [9] [E] [E] [C]  
-
To add a temporary passcode, enter:  
[A] [5] [6] [3] [0] [E] [E] [9] [8] [7] [E] [E] [D]  
[E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E] [1] [E]  
[1] [E] [1] [E] [C]  
If you plan to use only commands to operate the  
system, along with arming and disarming by  
entering a passcode, then you do not need to  
program Custom Function or Function List.  
This adds user 30, passcode 987 with  
authority level 1 in all areas.  
2.11.2 Command Center Selections  
Programming choices in this section determine if  
command center functions are disabled (blank),  
enabled (E), or restricted (P) panel-wide.  
-
To delete the passcode, enter:  
[A] [5] [3] [3] [0] [E] [E] [E] [C]  
To program multiple area Arming or Disarming  
functions, use keystroke sequences including  
COMMAND 50 (Move to Area) and  
COMMAND 1.  
Press the [SPACE ] bar to scroll through the  
selections. Press [ENTER] when the correct selection  
appears in the display.  
0101  
Table 25: Command Center Programming  
Choices  
Custom function cannot be used to change  
time (such as Daylight Savings Time). Use  
Skeds S## Function Codes 13 and 14 to  
adjust for Daylight Savings Time (see S##  
Custom Function prompt in Section 5.2  
Skeds.  
0101  
0101  
Selection  
Description  
Blank  
Disable the function panel-wide.  
Accessing the function using a  
command or the Function List  
displays NO AUTHORITY.  
2.11 User Interface  
Define which functions can be used by each of the  
fourteen user authority levels. Each user can be  
assigned the same or different authority level by  
area. The user has rights in the area where the  
command center is assigned based on the authority  
level assigned to the user’s passcode for that area.  
E
P
Enable the function panel-wide.  
The function can be executed  
without entering a passcode.  
Passcode required. When the  
passcode is entered at the  
command center, the control panel  
checks the user’s authority level.  
See Section 2.11.3 Authority  
Level Selections.  
When the passcode is entered at the command  
center, the control panel checks the authority level.  
The control panel executes the function only in  
areas where the passcode has the authority to use the  
function.  
2.11.1 Commands  
See Section 2.11.3 Authority Level  
Similr to command initiation used in other Bosch  
Security Systems products, the Commands method  
provides continuity in the arming commands across  
product lines and makes an easy transition for  
dealers using other Bosch Security Systems products.  
With commands, the end user presses  
Selections for a detailed description of the  
functions on the following pages. These  
parameters only determine if the authority  
level functions are passcode protected.  
[COMMAND] and then the numeral of the  
command to initiate. For example, [COMMAND][2]  
arms the perimeter of the area. Some prompts can  
only be accessed from a menu and is noted as such  
by (Menu Function only). To access these functions,  
press [MENU], enter the function number, and use  
the [PREV] and [NEXT] keys to scroll through the  
choices.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 54  
Master Arm Delay  
Perim Delay  
Default:  
P
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Blank, E, or P  
#5 Perimeter Delay Arm [COMMAND][3]  
P
Passcode: Required for all users with  
Master Arm Delay enabled for their  
authority level.  
Delay arms all Perimeter points in the area where  
the command center is assigned. Entry and exit  
delays are provided with this Arming function. This  
function does not cause a Perimeter Instant point to  
act as a Delay point.  
E
Enable: A user does not need a  
passcode to use [COMMAND][1].  
Blank  
Disable Master Arm Delay cannot be  
accessed in the function menu or  
initiated with a command even if this  
function is enabled for the user’s  
authority level.  
Watch Mode  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#2 Master Arm Delay [COMMAND][1]  
#6 Watch Mode [COMMAND][6]  
Use this arming function to master arm disarmed  
areas. If enabled, the following arming choices are  
available to the user with this authority.  
This function lets you know when a perimeter and  
Interior point programmed as P## Watch Point is  
faulted when the point is disarmed. Interior points  
do not emit a Watch Tone if the area is perimeter  
armed. This function provides command center  
audible/visual and optional relay activation (see A #  
Watch Mode in Section 2.13.1 Area Relays).  
Mstr Arm Inst  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Perim Partial  
#3 Master Arm Instant [COMMAND][1][1]  
Use this arming function to master arm instant areas  
that are disarmed. If enabled, the following arming  
choices are available to the user with this authority.  
Entry and exit delays are not provided with this  
arming function. This causes a Perimeter and  
Interior Delay point to act as an Instant point.  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#7 Perimeter Partial Arm [COMMAND][8]  
Arms normal Perimeter points only while other  
faulted Perimeter points programmed as P##  
Bypassable are ignored. Entry and exit delays are  
provided with this Arming function.  
Perim Instant  
Default:  
P
Perim Partial ignores the A# FA Bypass  
Max entry in Section 2.9 Area Parameters.  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#4 Perimeter Instant Arm [COMMAND][2]  
Instant arms all perimeter points with a P## Point  
Response that initiates an instant alarm (see P## Pt  
Response in Section 4.1.1 Point Responses) in the area  
where the command center is assigned. Entry and  
exit delays are not provided with this arming  
function. This function causes a Perimeter Delay  
point to act as a Perimeter Instant point.  
Local Only Reporting: No Closing Report  
is sent to the central station, but a  
Perimeter Delay Closing Event is  
generated in the event log.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 55  
View Area Stat  
Fire Test  
Default:  
P
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Blank, E, or P  
#8 View Area Status (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Use this function to view the armed status of all  
areas within the scope of the command center  
assigned to this area. The armed states include A#  
AREA # IS OFF (disarmed), A# AREA # IS ON  
(master delay armed), ALL ON INSTANT (master  
instant armed), and AREA # PERIM ON (perimeter  
instant armed or perimeter delay armed). All area  
types, master, associate, regular, and shared can be  
viewed using this function.  
#12 Fire Test [COMMAND][5][8]  
Use this function to test 24-hour points in areas  
within the scope of the command center where the  
function is entered. Controlled points, P## Type 1,  
2, 3, cannot be tested using the Fire Walk Test  
Mode.  
Send Report  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
View Memory  
#13 Send Report [COMMAND][4][1] or  
[COMMAND][4][2]  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Use this function to test the communication link  
between the control panel and the central station  
receiver(s). It can send a Test Report or a Status  
Report to the phone numbers programmed in  
Routing. The Test Report includes additional  
information if Expand Test Rpt is enabled in Section  
2.1 Phone.  
#9 View Event Memory [COMMAND][4][0]  
Use this function to view prior alarm, trouble, and  
supervisory activity occurring since the last time the  
system armed. Event memory is not cleared until the  
area is re-armed.  
Access Control Functions  
View Pt Status  
Door Control  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Default:  
P
#10 View Point Status (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Use this function to view points assigned to the area  
where the command center is assigned. This  
function shows point text and the electrical condition  
(normal, open, short, and missing) of each point in  
the area.  
#14 Door Control [COMMAND][4][6])  
This top level display must be enabled for the user  
to access the cycle door, unlock door, and secure  
Door functions (see Section 2.11.3 Authority Level  
Selections). Use this item when programming door  
control in your function menu.  
Walk Test  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#11 Walk Test [COMMAND][4][4]  
Use this function to test Controlled points in areas  
within the command center’s scope without sending  
reports to the central station. 24-hour points cannot  
be tested using this Walk Test Mode.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 56  
Access Ctl Level  
Add User  
Default:  
P
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Blank, E, or P  
#37 Access Control Levels (MENU FUNCTION  
only)  
#18 Add User [COMMAND][5][6]  
Use this function to add/change passcodes,  
add/change tokens/cards and Sub-users, and  
add/change control panel authority levels (L##) by  
area.  
Shows the current on/off state of control levels 1  
through 14, pertaining to Access Control Only,  
(L## Access Level and L## Disarm Level). It  
allows the user to toggle levels on and off and  
prevent access control levels from being valid during  
an extended period. This change only affects the  
user’s token/cards, it does not affect command  
center Door Control functions.  
Del User  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#19 Delete User [COMMAND][5][3]  
Chg Display  
Use this function to delete a user’s passcode and  
tokens/cards. It does not delete user names.  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
This function deletes the passcode,  
master user, and all sub-users associated  
with the user number.  
#15 Change Display [COMMAND][4][9]  
Use this function to select either a bright or dim  
display with loud or soft command center warning  
tones. You can also choose the time/date display.  
Extend Close  
Default:  
P
Chg Time/Date  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Default:  
E
#20 Extend Close [COMMAND][5][1]  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Use this function to change the expected closing  
time for the area. The window cannot be adjusted  
until the Close Early Begin time passes and the  
Closing Window is active.  
#16 Change Time and Date [COMMAND][4][5]  
Use this function to set the time and date in the  
control panel.  
Chg Passcode  
View Log  
Default:  
P
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#17 Change Passcodes [COMMAND][5][5]  
#21 View Log (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Use this function to change your passcode. This is a  
panel-wide function that can be executed from any  
command center assigned to an area where the user  
has authority.  
Use this function to view all of the main events Door  
Cycle and the main event modifiers By User in the  
event log memory. User Name and Point Text are  
NOT stored in the event log but appear when the  
control panel matches them with both the user ID  
### and the point ###.  
Regardless of whether an E or a P is  
entered when a COMMAND 55 is  
performed, the command center prompts  
for the user’s current passcode first.  
Each main event takes up one line in the log. Each  
modifier also takes up one line in the log.  
The log in the control panel can store between 500  
and 1000 events in the control panel log.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 57  
Print Log  
Unbypass a Pt  
Default:  
P
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Blank, E, or P  
#22 Print Event Log (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Use this function to print all the events stored in the  
control panel starting at the start date and ending  
with the last event in the log.  
#26 Unbypass a Point [COMMAND][0][0]  
Use this function to unbypass individual points that  
are programmed either P## FA Retrnable or P##  
Bypass Returnable. Points within the scope of the  
command center can be unbypassed where the  
function is entered (see Section 2.10.1 Cmd Cntr  
(Command Center) Assignment). The control panel  
responds to alarms/troubles and displays point faults  
when a point is unbypassed.  
User Cmd 7  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#23 User COMMAND 7 [COMMAND][7]  
Reset Sensors  
Use this function to activate an alarm programmed  
in COMMAND 7 in the RADXPNTS Handler.  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
User Cmd 9  
#27 Reset Sensors [COMMAND][4][7]  
Default:  
P
Use this function to activate the Reset Sensors  
function for Fire or Intrusion points programmed as  
P## Resettable in Section 4.1 Point Index. Points  
within the scope of the command center where the  
function is entered resets (see Section 2.10.1 Cmd Cntr  
(Command Center) Assignment).  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#24 User COMMAND 9 [COMMAND][9]  
Use this function to activate an alarm programmed  
in COMMAND 9 in the RADXPNTS Handler.  
Bypass a Pt  
Change Relay  
Default:  
P
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#25 Bypass a Point [COMMAND][0]  
#28 Change Relays [COMMAND][5][4]  
Use this function to bypass individual points that are  
P## Bypassable. Points within the scope of the  
command center can be bypassed where the  
function is entered (see Section 2.10.1 Cmd Cntr  
(Command Center) Assignment).  
Use this function to manually set and reset Relays 1  
through 128 (1 through 64 in a D7412G) installed in  
the system.  
Remote Program  
The control panel ignores alarms/troubles and does  
not display point faults when a point is bypassed.  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#29 Remote Programming [COMMAND][4][3]  
Use this function to initiate RAM sessions. When the  
phone is ringing at the control panel, initiating this  
function causes the control panel to seize the line.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 58  
Move to Area  
Default Text  
Default:  
P
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Blank, E, or P  
#30 Move to Area [COMMAND][5][0]  
#34 Default Text [COMMAND][5][7]  
Use this function to temporarily switch the  
command center’s assignment to a different area.  
This can be used to perform any function that can  
be performed by a command center assigned to the  
area in programming.  
It may be difficult to determine the armed state of an  
area using the programmed custom text. Use this  
function to temporarily switch to the control panel  
default text, shown on the Program Record Sheet.  
Change Skeds  
Users are limited to performing functions enabled by  
the authority level they have in the area to which the  
command center is moved. After 15 seconds of no  
activity at the keypad, the command center reverts  
back to the originally programmed area.  
Default:  
P
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#35 Change Skeds [COMMAND][5][2]  
Execute this panel-wide function from any command  
center assigned to an area where the user has  
authority. Use this function to change the S## Time  
from the command center to make adjustments to  
Skeds.  
Display Rev  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#32 Display Software Revision  
[COMMAND][5][9]  
Custom Functions  
C Function 128 [through 143]  
Use this function to show the control panel’s  
software revision number in the command center  
display.  
Default:  
E
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
Service Walk  
128 to 143 Enable Custom Functions 128 through  
143 (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Default:  
P
Determines whether or not a passcode is required  
when accessing a custom function from the menu  
list. ENTER PASSCODE(or Enter Passcode +  
Enter Keyon the D1260) displays when this  
function is passcode protected. If a command within  
the Custom Function is passcode protected, the  
command center displays ENTER PASSCODE(or  
Enter Passcode + Enter Keyon the D1260)  
and waits for the user to enter a valid passcode  
before proceeding with the rest of the Custom  
Function. If a passcode is not entered within 10  
seconds, the Custom Function times out and the  
display returns to idle text.  
Selection:  
Blank, E, or P  
#33 Service Walk Test (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Use this function to Walk Test all 246 points in the  
entire control panel regardless of the P## Type.  
The Service Walk Test is available on the  
D9412G using the Service Menu  
[9][9][ENT]. The D7412G does NOT  
include the Service Walk Test in the  
Service Menu. The D7412G needs the  
Service Walk Test function enabled in the  
Function List to access the Service Walk  
Test.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 59  
2.11.3 Authority Level Selections  
0101  
01  
0101  
There are many options available for  
Use Section 2.11.3 Authority Level Selections to  
determine which Authority Level can access  
command center functions that are Passcode  
Protected. You do not need to select Enable items  
in the Authority Level section if the command  
center function is disabled or enabled. There are two  
selections you can use for each individual function  
for the authority level you are programming.  
arming and disarming. This depends on A#  
Area Type and CC# Scope. Read the  
definitions of area type in Section 2.9 Area  
Parameters and CC# Scope in Section  
2.10.1 Cmd Cntr (Command Center)  
Assignment.  
L## Master Arm Delay  
Press the [SPACE] bar to scroll through the  
selections. Press [ENTER] when the correct selection  
appears in the display.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
#2 Master Arm Delay [COMMAND][1]  
Table 26: Authority Level Selections  
Master arms areas based on the CC# Scope of the  
command center using an exit delay time.  
Authority Level Description  
When this item is accessed through the Function  
List, Master Arm All allows the user to arm all areas  
according to the authority level of the user and  
within the CC# Scope of the command center using  
an exit delay time.  
Blank  
E
Disabled: This function is not  
authorized for the user who is  
assigned this authority level.  
Enabled: This function is authorized  
for the user who is assigned this  
authority level.  
Arm Area arms only the area displayed.  
If COMMAND 1 is used, it arms only the area  
where the command center is assigned.  
Authority Level  
.L## Mstr Arm Inst  
Default:  
1
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection:  
1 to 14  
Selection: Blank or E  
Enter the number of the authority level you want to  
program. Authority Level 15 (Service Passcode)  
cannot be edited.  
#3 Master Arm Instant [COMMAND][1][1]  
When this item is accessed through the Function  
List, Master Arm Inst allows the user to arm all areas  
according to the user’s authority level and within the  
CC# Scope of the command center being used  
without an exit delay time by accessing the Function  
Menu.  
L## Disarm  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
#1 Disarm  
Arm Area arms only the area to which the  
command center is assigned.  
Use the disarming function to disarm areas that are  
master armed or perimeter armed. If enabled, the  
following disarming choices are available to the user  
with this authority.  
If COMMAND 11 is used, it arms only the area  
where the command center is assigned.  
Use COMMAND 11 carefully because all  
Perimeter and Interior points become  
Instant Armed.  
DISARM ALL: Disarms all areas within the CC#  
Scope of the command center being used by  
accessing the Function Menu and the authority level  
of the user performing the function.  
DISARM AREA: Disarms only the displayed area.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 60  
L## View Memory  
L## Perim Instant  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Selection: Blank or E  
#9 View Event Memory [COMMAND][4][0]  
#4 Perimeter Instant Arm [COMMAND][2]  
View all memory events that occurred since the last  
time the system was armed for all areas within the  
scope of the command center in this area.  
Instant arm all Perimeter points, including Delayed  
points, only in the area where the command center  
is assigned.  
L## View Pt Status  
L## Perim Delay  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Selection: Blank or E  
#10 View Point Status (MENU FUNCTION only)  
#5 Perimeter Delay Arm [COMMAND][3]  
View the current status of all points in the area to  
which this command center is assigned.  
Delay arm all Perimeter Delay point responses only  
in the area where the command center is assigned.  
L## Walk Test  
L## Watch Mode  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Selection: Blank or E  
#11 Walk Test [COMMAND][4][4]  
#6 Watch Mode [COMMAND][6]  
Initiate a Walk Test for all Interior/Perimeter  
Controlled points in the area to which this command  
center is assigned.  
Initiate the Watch Mode in the area to which this  
command center is assigned.  
L## Perim Partial  
The following features are provided with the Walk  
Test Mode:  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
During this test, the battery powers the control  
panel only. A Battery Test is initiated during the  
full duration of the test to ensure the battery  
capacity is capable of supporting the full load of  
the control panel while AC is failed.  
Selection: Blank or E  
#7 Perimeter Partial Arm [COMMAND][8]  
Partially arms only the area where the command  
center is assigned.  
-
This test includes an initial 2-second Bell  
Test when starting the Walk Test.  
This function ignores the A# FA Bypass  
Max entry in Area Parameters.  
-
The test ends once all points are tested or  
until the test times out after 20 minutes of  
no activity.  
0101  
Local Only Reporting: No Closing  
0101  
Local alarm annunciation and event printing  
without reporting to the central station receiver.  
Report is sent to the central station, but a  
Perimeter Delay Closing Event is  
generated in the event log.  
001  
D1255 command center displays a sequential  
count after each point is activated and restored  
as well as the text for the point.  
L## View Area Stat  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
The command center displays ALL PTS  
TESTEDand an All Points Tested Event is  
reported to the central station receiver (if  
programmed) when the last point is tested.  
Selection: Blank or E  
#8 View Area Status (MENU FUNCTION only)  
View the current arm/disarm and not ready to arm  
status of all areas within the scope of the command  
center in this area. The user needs arming/disarming  
authority.  
If enabled in Routing, Walk Start and Walk End  
are reported at the central station receiver for  
the beginning and end of the test.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 61  
Access Control Functions  
To Walk Test a Door point connected to a  
D9210B Access Interface Module, the  
door must be opened without activating  
the door sequence or allowing it to time  
out past the extended shunt time.  
The following functions enable the user to control  
the doors using the command center. Users can have  
authority to access the Door Control and can use  
either all or part of the functions within.  
L## Fire Test  
All doors display when this function is  
chosen. This function does not follow the  
scope of the command center.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
L## Door Control  
#12 Fire Test [COMMAND][5][8]  
Initiate a Fire Walk Test for all 24-hour points in the  
area where this command center is assigned.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
When a Fire Test is initiated, one person can test a  
fire system without assistance. The following features  
are provided with the Fire Test Mode:  
#14 Door Control [COMMAND][4][6]  
This item only allows programming access to the  
following three sub-prompts. It does not affect the  
user’s access to Cycle Door, Unlock Door, and  
Secure Door.  
During this test, the battery powers the control  
panel only. A Battery Test is initiated during the  
full duration of the test to ensure the battery  
capacity is capable of supporting the full load of  
the control panel while AC is failed.  
Cycle Door, Unlock Door, and Secure  
Door cannot be accessed through the  
Function List. Door Control must be added  
to the Function List to access the door  
control functions, or COMMAND 46 may  
be used.  
-
This test includes a 2-second Bell Test (Fire  
Bell relay) for each Fire point that is tested.  
-
The test ends once all points are tested or  
until the test times out after 20 minutes of  
no activity.  
The following prompts are sub-functions of Door  
Control. They become visible in the D5200  
Programmer when you Enable Door Control and  
press [ENTER] on the D5200.  
Local alarm annunciation and event printing  
without reporting to the central station receiver.  
Automatic smoke detector reset Sensors  
Resetting for all Fire points programmed with  
P## Resettable as Yes.  
0101  
Cycle Door must be enabled for all three  
0101  
sub-functions to operate. If Cycle Door is  
disabled, all three sub-functions do not  
operate.  
001  
D1255 command center displays a sequential  
count after each point is activated and restored,  
as well as the text for the point.  
L## Cycle Door  
If enabled in Routing, Fire Walk Start and Fire  
Walk End are reported at the central station  
receiver for the beginning and end of the test.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Cycle Door (MENU FUNCTION only)  
A# Verify Time for Fire points  
programmed with P## Alarm Verify as  
Yes is ignored during the Fire Walk Test.  
Press the command center number keys [1] through  
[8] that correspond to the door number to cycle  
doors. For example, pressing [2] and [ENTER]  
cycles door number 2, which is indicated by Cin the  
display.  
L## Send Report  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Cycle Door allows the user with this authority level  
to access the CYCLE? 12345678 function.  
Selection: Blank or E  
#13 Send Report [COMMAND][4][1] or  
[COMMAND][4][2]  
Send a Test Report from any command center  
assigned to an area where the user has authority.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 62  
L## Unlock Door  
Table 27: L## Secure Door-Door Mode  
Definitions  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Door State  
Definition  
Unlock Door (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Lock Door  
Normal Door: When a door is in the  
Lock Door state, one can initiate the  
door sequence using Skeds, CYCLE  
DOOR?,command center functions,  
door requests, and valid token/card  
requests.  
No Access Allowed: When a door is  
in the Secure Door state, no access  
is allowed through the door until it is  
returned to the Lock Door state. This  
includes Sked and command center  
functions.  
Free Access: When a door is in the  
Unlocked Door state, the door is  
already shunted and the strike does  
not prevent the door from opening. In  
this state, the user does not need to  
activate a door request or present a  
valid token/card.  
Momentary Access: This is a  
temporary Door Mode in which the  
door initiates the door sequence as if  
a valid token/card was read. This  
state occurs using the command  
center and RAM. A sked cannot  
activate this state.  
Press the command center number keys [1] through  
[8] that correspond to the door number to  
unlock/relock doors. For example, pressing [2] and  
[ENTER] unlocks door number 2, which is indicated  
by Uin the display.  
Unlock Door allows the user with this authority level  
to access the UNLOCK? 12345678 function.  
Secure Door  
Unlock Door  
L## Secure Door  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Secure Door (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Press the command center number keys [1] through  
[8] that correspond to the door number to  
secure/unsecure doors. For example, pressing [2]  
and [ENTER] secures door number 2, which is  
indicated by an Xin the display.  
Secure Door allows the user with this authority level  
to access the SECURE? 12345678 function.  
Cycle Door  
L## Access Ctl Lvl  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
#37 Access Control Levels (MENU FUNCTION  
only)  
Changing the Access Control Level in any  
area affects all users and all doors  
associated with that level for all areas.  
Access Level Ctl allows the user with this authority  
level to enable/disable access control levels for all  
doors activated in the control panel regardless of the  
area in which the doors are assigned.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 63  
0101  
0101  
001  
L## Chg Display  
Although an individual user (001 through  
249) can be deleted separately, take  
caution. User passcode, token/cards  
cannot be deleted individually within a  
group (for example, User 001 has three  
additional sub-users that use the same  
authority levels for that group). When  
dealing with an individual user, change  
that user’s token/passcode so other  
users in the group do not need to be re-  
added.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
#15 Change Display [COMMAND][4][9]  
Change the display (bright display, dim display, and  
time display) in the area where this command center  
is assigned.  
L## Chg Time/Date  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
L## Extend Close  
Selection: Blank or E  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
#16 Change Time and Date [COMMAND][4][5]  
Selection: Blank or E  
#20 Extend Close [COMMAND][5][1]  
Change the date and time for the control panel in  
this area.  
Change the closing time in the area where the  
function is entered.  
L## Chg Passcode  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
L## View Log  
Selection: Blank or E  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
#17 Change Passcodes [COMMAND][5][5]  
Change a user passcode.  
Selection: Blank or E  
#21 View Log (MENU FUNCTION only)  
L## Add User  
View all panel-wide events in the control panel’s  
memory log.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
L## Print Log  
#18 Add User [COMMAND][5][6]  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Add/change users, add/change authority levels,  
add/change tokens/cards.  
Selection: Blank or E  
#22 Print Event Log (MENU FUNCTION only)  
9210 NOT READYappears if a door  
controller is not assigned (see CC#  
Assign Door in Section 2.10.1 Cmd Cntr  
(Command Center) Assignment) to the  
command center used to add/change  
tokens/cards.  
Print all panel-wide events from the log to the  
printer in the area where the user is executing this  
function.  
This item can also be accessed using the  
Service Menu ([9][9][ENT]).  
L## Del User  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
L## User Cmd 7  
Selection: Blank or E  
#19 Delete User [COMMAND][5][3]  
Delete users.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
#23 User COMMAND 7 [COMMAND][7]  
Can be used in Function Menu. Generate the alarm  
programmed at COMMAND 7 in the RADXPNTS  
Handler.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 64  
L## Move to Area  
L## User Cmd 9  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
#30 Move to Area [COMMAND][5][0]  
Selection: Blank or E  
#24 User COMMAND 9 [COMMAND][9]  
Temporarily switch to a different area and perform  
command center functions related to the area to  
which the command center is switched.  
Can be used in Function Menu. Generate the alarm  
programmed at COMMAND 9 in the RADXPNTS  
Handler.  
L## Display Rev  
L## Bypass a Pt  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Selection: Blank or E  
#32 Display Software Revision  
[COMMAND][5][9]  
#25 Bypass a Point [COMMAND][0]  
Bypass points with this authority level  
Display the control panel software revision 9412  
REV ##.##.  
L## Unbypass a Pt  
L## Service Walk  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
#26 Unbypass a Point [COMMAND][0][0]  
Unbypass points with this authority level.  
Selection: Blank or E  
#33 Service Walk Test (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Initiate a Service Walk Test for all 24-hour  
Interior/Perimeter Controlled points in the control  
panel.  
L## Reset Sensors  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Points are not included in this test if:  
#27 Reset Sensors [COMMAND][4][7]  
Reset sensors with this authority level.  
Points are in an area that is already in a Walk  
Test Mode.  
Points are assigned to an area that is not enabled  
A# Area On.  
L## Change Relay  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Points are in an area that is Master or Perimeter  
armed.  
Selection: Blank or E  
When a Service Walk Test is initiated, one  
person can test all the points in the control panel  
without assistance. The following features are  
provided with the Service Test Mode:  
#28 Change Relays [COMMAND][5][4]  
Set RELAY ON? and reset RELAY OFF? relays in  
the control panel.  
Do not use the Chg Relays? function to  
toggle relays reserved for special  
functions. Special function relays are Area  
and Panel Wide Relay functions as well as  
relays assigned to CC# Entr Key Rly?.  
-
-
-
Display tells you exactly how many points  
can be tested.  
A Battery and Bell Test does not occur  
during this Walk Test.  
The test ends once all points are tested or  
until the test times out after 20 minutes of  
inactivity.  
L## Remote Program  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
-
Local event printing without alarm  
annunciation or reporting to the central  
station receiver.  
Selection: Blank or E  
#29 Remote Programming [COMMAND][4][3]  
Initiate a RAM session once the phone rings at the  
control panel.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 65  
-
D1255 command center displays a  
sequential count after each point is activated  
and restored as well as the text for the point.  
Report Levels  
L## Force Arm  
-
-
The D1255 command center displays ALL  
PNTS TESTED.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
If enabled in Routing, Service Start and  
Service End are reported at the central  
station receiver for the beginning and end of  
the test.  
Allows a user with this authority level to Force Arm.  
L## Area O/C  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Point 128 and Point 248 appear as missing. This is  
normal. These points are used for supervising the  
Zonex bus 1 (Point 128) and Zonex bus 2 (Point  
248). If these points indicate a short, the Zonex bus  
has a fault.  
Selection: Blank or E  
Generate Opening and Closing Reports if the area  
where this authority level is assigned sends Opening  
and Closing Reports.  
Extra points can be viewed using this function. Extra  
points occur under two conditions: an extra point is  
a point wired electrically to the Zonex bus with a  
blank P### Point Index, or two Zonex devices  
exist for the same Zonex address.  
L## Restricted O/C  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Initiate an Opening Report if a bell is ringing or a  
Closing Report when force/bypass arming. The area  
where this authority level is assigned must be  
programmed for restricted openings and closings  
(see the A# Restrictd O/C prompt in Section 2.9.5  
Open/Close Options)  
L## Default Text  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
#34 Default Text [COMMAND][5][7]  
Temporarily display the armed state of the area  
using control panel default text, A# AREA # IS ON,  
A# NOT READY, A# AREA # IS OFF, and A#  
ACCOUNT IS ON.  
.L## Perimeter O/C  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
L## Change Skeds  
Report Perimeter Opening and Closing Reports if  
the area where this authority level is assigned sends  
Perimeter Opening and Closing Reports.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
L## Send Duress  
#35 Change Skeds [COMMAND][5][2]  
Change skeds that can be edited.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Skeds can be restricted from being edited  
Send a Duress Report if the area where this  
authority level is assigned sends duress. (See the A#  
Duress Enable prompt in Section 2.9 Area  
Parameters).  
by programming S## Time Edit? to No.  
Custom Functions  
L## C Function 128 [through 143]  
L## Passcode Arm  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Selection: Blank or E  
128 to 143 Enable Custom Function 128 through  
143 (MENU FUNCTION only)  
Arm an area by entering a passcode and pressing  
[ENTER].  
Execute the desired Custom Function.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 66  
L## Passcode Disarm  
L## Disarm Level  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank or E  
Selection: I, D, or Blank  
Disarm an area by entering a passcode and pressing  
[ENTER].  
I
Users change the Master Armed state  
and Perimeter Armed state to  
Perimeter Instant. The armed state  
does not change in other areas, and the  
armed state does not change if the area  
is already in the perimeter instant or  
disarmed state. User needs access level  
for Master Armed (M) state.  
Access Control Levels  
L## Security Level  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: M, P, D, or Blank  
D
Users change the local area’s Master  
Armed state and Perimeter Armed  
state to the Disarm state. User needs  
access level for Master Armed (M) or  
Perimeter Armed (P) state. All areas  
within the scope of the command  
center assigned to the D# CC# Scope  
in the access handler, and areas to  
which the user has disarm rights,  
disarm as programmed.  
M
P
Users have access rights for this area  
when the area is in any armed state.  
Users have access rights for this area  
when the area is Perimeter Armed or  
disarmed but not while the area is  
Master Armed.  
D
Users have access rights for this area  
only while it is disarmed.  
Blank  
Users do not have access rights to this  
area.  
Blank  
Users do not have disarm rights in this  
area.  
Security Level [TOKEN FUNCTION]  
When the user presents a token/card at the reader,  
access is granted only when the user has the  
authority to enter the area under certain armed  
conditions.  
Burglar bells are silenced in the local area  
when a user disarms with a token/card or  
presents the token/card during an alarm.  
The user must use a passcode to silence  
a Fire Bell. Cancel Reports are sent after  
a valid passcode or token/card silences  
the bell.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Opening and Closing Reports are sent to  
the central station receiver if programmed.  
For more information on programming this  
prompt for a shared area, see Access  
Control Readers Assigned to the Shared  
Area in Section 2.9.3 Shared-Area  
Characteristics.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 67  
2.12 Function List  
M## CC Address 1 [through 8]  
Default: See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
The Function List is accessed when the user presses  
[MENU] (or the key corresponding to menu) on the  
D1260) while the command center is displaying the  
idle text. Up to 32 functions M### Function(s) can  
be programmed.  
Yes  
This menu item appears at this  
command center address.  
Each CC # command center address can display a  
combination of all/each of the 32 menu items. The  
D1255 displays one menu item at a time. The D1260  
displays up to two menu items at a time. Enabling  
the function in the menu list does this by command  
center address. The function name shown in the  
Functions column on the record sheet appears in the  
command center display in capital letters. For  
example, WATCH MODEdisplays for #6 Watch  
Mode.  
No  
This menu item does not appear at this  
command center address.  
Programming this prompt determines at which CC  
address setting this Menu Item appears.  
2.13 Relay Parameters  
Relays provide dry contact (normally open/closed)  
outputs for LED annunciation and other applications  
as well as wet (12 VDC on/off) voltage outputs for  
basic alarm system functions (such as Bell Output or  
Reset Sensors). The applications are endless, but  
primarily, relays are used to enhance a system’s  
capability to perform output functions.  
Menu Item  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: 1 to 32  
Panel-Wide Relays: These relays provide an  
output related to a panel-wide indication. For  
annunciation, these relays can indicate system  
wide troubles for power, phone, and overall  
control panel summary of alarms, troubles, and  
supervisory conditions.  
Enter the menu item number you are programming.  
The M## Function displays sequentially in the order  
they are programmed. (M 1 Function is the first  
function that appears in the menu and M 32  
Function is the last function that appears when  
scrolling through the menu).  
Area Relays: These relays provide an output by  
the area that the relay is assigned to. An area  
can have its own bell and sensor reset  
indications. Relays can also indicate the area  
armed state and whether any off normal  
conditions such as a force arm occurred.  
0101  
01  
0101  
A failure to program Menu Item 1 causes  
COMMAND DISABLEDto appear in the  
command center display.  
M## Function  
On Board Relays: There are three on-board 12  
VDC voltage-outputs that provide power when  
activated on the control panel. These outputs are  
default programmed from the factory as Relays  
A, B, and C. Typically, Relay A (Terminal 6) is  
used for the bell, Relay B (Terminal 7) is used  
for an alternate alarm output (such as another  
bell), and Relay C (Terminal 8) is used for  
Sensor Reset (Relays B and C require the  
optional D136 Relays).  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 30, 32 to 35, 37, and  
128 to 143  
Enter the function number indicated in the “#”  
column of the Program Record Sheet and next to the  
function in Section 2.11 User Interface.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Function numbers 128 to 143 are custom  
functions and display the text programmed  
for CF ### Text.  
Off-Board Relays: The D9412G can also  
control 128 (64 for the D7412G) dry contact  
form C relays when up to sixteen optional  
D8129 OctoRelay Modules are installed. These  
relays are used for Area Relay, Panel-Wide  
Relay, and Individual Point Fault Relays.  
There is no restriction on how many times  
you may assign a specific function to the  
menu. By doing so, you can assign the  
same function at different command  
centers so they appear differently in some  
areas than in others.  
Relay Follows Point: Relays can also be used  
to activate when a point programmed for P##  
RlyResp Type (in Section 4.1 Point Index) is off  
normal or in alarm condition.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 68  
Relay Reports: When relay activity is reported  
to the receiver (see Section 2.3 Routing), on-board  
relays are reported as follows: A = 253, B = 254,  
C = 255. The others report as 001 to 128. The  
Relay Report is RELAY SET RELAY # rrr  
when the relay is turned on and RELAY RESET  
RELAY # rrr when the relay is turned off. Relay  
Reports are also printed on the local printer and  
stored in the control panel memory log.  
0101  
0101  
001  
Check relay status after reprogramming  
or resetting the control panel. All relays  
are turned off after the control panel  
resets. The control panel checks certain  
relay functions each minute and resumes  
the correct state after the reset. Other  
relays must be manually set to the correct  
state using the Change Relay Function  
(COMMAND 54).  
Controlling Relays: As mentioned, relays can  
be activated depending upon conditions that  
exist with the control panel. In addition, relays  
can be controlled by the user using the Chg  
Relay? function, Relay On/Relay Off skeds, and  
the Remote Account Manager.  
These Relay functions resume the proper  
state within 1 minute:  
Alarm Bell  
Perimeter Fault  
Summary Trouble  
Reset Sensors  
AC Fail  
Summary Fire  
Area Armed  
Fire Bell  
Review the following programming tips, notes, and  
applications before programming your relays.  
Summary Alarm  
Silent Alarm  
Area Fault  
Phone Fail  
Summary SupBurg  
Battery Trouble  
DO NOT use the CHG RELAYS? function  
to toggle relays reserved for special  
functions. Special function relays are Area  
and Panel Wide Relay functions as well as  
relays assigned to CC Entr Key Rly and  
P## RlyResp Type.  
Summary Fire Tbl Communications Fail  
Watch Mode Summary SupFire  
These Relay functions must be manually  
reset with Change Relay function  
(COMMAND 54):  
Fail To Close  
Duress  
Force Armed  
Log % Full  
Relay C is always on. Assigning any other  
relay (1 to 128, A or B) deactivates Relay C  
so this output can be used for other  
functions. When Relay C is programmed for  
A# Rest Sensors, power is always supplied  
from Terminal 8 of the control panel.  
2.13.1 Area Relays  
Each area can be assigned a unique relay number  
for each of the events listed in this section.  
Area  
Default:  
1
Selection: 1 to 8  
Enter the area number you are programming.  
A# Alarm Bell  
Default:  
A
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
This voltage output relay activates and provides  
12 VDC output when a Non-fire point (P## Fire is  
No) assigned to this area goes into alarm.  
0101  
Burg Time and Burg Pat must be  
01  
programmed in Bell Parameters. This relay  
activates according to the bell pattern and  
remains active until the bell time expires.  
P## Silent Bell must be No for the bell to  
ring upon alarm.  
0101  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 69  
A# Fire Bell  
0101  
01  
0101  
When sharing one relay to reset sensors in  
two or more areas, you must program the  
following. Failure to do so causes  
TROUBLE PT ### for all point types  
programmed as P## Resettable.  
Default:  
A
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
This voltage output relay activates and provides  
12 VDC output when a Fire point (P## Fire is Yes)  
assigned to this area goes into alarm.  
CC # Scope must include all the areas  
that are sharing the relay.  
L## Reset Sensors for the user  
initiating the sensor reset must be  
enabled for all the areas that are  
sharing the relay.  
0101  
Fire Time and Fire Pat must be  
01  
programmed in Bell Parameters. This relay  
activates according to the bell pattern and  
remains active until the bell time expires.  
P## Silent Bell must be No in order for  
the bell to ring upon alarm.  
0101  
A# Verify Time must be the same  
number of seconds for all the areas  
that are sharing the relay.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Although Relay C is a valid entry for A#  
Fire Bell, do not program Relay C for this  
entry.  
A# Fail to Close  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
A# Reset Sensors  
Default:  
C
Activates when the Closing Window expires for the  
specified area. It remains activated until midnight, or  
until another Closing Window starts, or the control  
panel is reset, whichever occurs first.  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Unlike the default relay for Alarm Bell and Fire Bell,  
this voltage-output relay (Relay C) de-activates for 5  
seconds when the Reset Sensors?function is  
initiated from the command center or during a Fire  
Walk Test.  
See Programming Tip #5 in this section  
for additional relay functions.  
A# Force Armed  
The Reset Sensor time converts from the  
5 second default time to the time  
programmed in A# Verify Time (see  
Section 2.9 Area Parameters) when a  
point programmed for P## Alarm Verify  
(Section 4.1 Point Index) goes into an  
alarm condition.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Activates when this area is Force Armed. It remains  
activated until the area is disarmed or the control  
panel is reset.  
When perimeter force arming, this relay  
does not activate.  
A# Watch Mode  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Activates when a Controlled point programmed for  
P## Watch Point is tripped in the specified area  
while the area is in Watch Mode and the point is not  
armed. It remains activated for 2 seconds after each  
point is faulted.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 70  
0101  
01  
0101  
A# Area Armed  
Burg Time needs a bell period  
programmed and A# Duress Enable must  
be Yes. This relay activates steadily  
regardless of bell pattern and remains  
active until the bell time expires.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Activates when the specified area becomes master  
armed (exit delay must expire before the relay  
activates). The relay remains activated until the area  
is disarmed. It does not deactivate during the entry  
delay time.  
A# Perim Fault  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
If multiple areas use the same relay, the relay  
activates when all areas are armed. It deactivates  
when the first area disarms.  
The relay activates when a Controlled Perimeter  
point (P## Type 1) assigned to the specified area is  
faulted. This relay activates regardless of the areas  
armed state. This relay provides a steady output until  
all Perimeter points in the area return to normal.  
Programming a 64 in Area 8’s Silent Alarm  
relay causes the Area Armed relay to  
energize at the beginning of the exit delay  
time.  
This relay does not activate on interior  
faults. To detect all area point faults,  
program all points as Perimeter points in  
the area where this relay is assigned.  
Keyswitch area armed status with LEDs.  
Use a D8129 Module and connect an LED  
to display the armed state.  
A# Silent Alarm  
Alternate communication trigger: This  
output relay can be used to trigger the  
input zone of a device being used as a  
slave to report control panel arming status.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
This relay activates when a point assigned to the  
specified area and programmed for P## Silent Bell  
goes into alarm.  
A# Area Fault  
Default:  
Blank  
0101  
Programming Tip #1: Burg Time needs a  
bell period programmed. This relay  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
01  
0101  
activates according to the bell pattern and  
remains active until the bell time expires or  
a valid passcode is entered.  
The relay activates whenever a controlled (P##  
Type 1, 2, 3 only) Perimeter or Interior point is  
faulted. The relay remains activated until all  
Perimeter and Interior points in the area are normal.  
0101  
Programming Tip #2: Programming 64 in  
01  
Keyswitch area armed status with LEDs.  
Use a D8129 Module and connect an LED  
to light when this relay is activated  
Area 8’s Silent Alarm Relay causes the  
Area Armed or Perimeter Armed Relay  
(see Programming Tip #5) to energize at  
the beginning of the exit delay time.  
0101  
indicating that the area is not ready to arm.  
A# Duress Relay  
0101  
01  
0101  
Programming Tip #3: Programming a  
non-zero value in Area 5’s Silent Alarm  
Relay enables Ground Fault Detect on the  
D9412G or D7412G Control Panels. See  
the D9412G/D7412G Operation and  
Installation Guide regarding Ground Fault  
Detect.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
The relay activates when a Duress alarm is  
generated from a command center assigned to the  
specified area.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 71  
2.13.2 Panel-Wide Relays  
0101  
Programming Tip #4:  
01  
The following eleven relay options activate when  
they occur anywhere in the control panel. They are  
not restricted by area boundaries.  
0101  
Fire Trouble Resound was added to  
firmware versions 6.20 and later. This  
feature, when enabled, resounds the Fire  
Trouble condition at 12:00 PM or 12:00  
AM if the Fire Trouble condition still exists.  
It does not, however, retransmit the Fire  
Trouble condition at the specified time.  
The Fire Trouble Event is only sent, if  
programmed to do so, at the time it  
occurs.  
AC Failure  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Activates when the control panel responds to an AC  
power failure as programmed in AC Fail Time in  
Section 2.5 Power Supervision. This relay automatically  
resets when AC power is restored.  
To disable the Fire Trouble Resound  
feature, program a 0 in Area 6’s Silent  
Alarm Relay entry.  
Use this relay as an option to create  
audible annunciation using the command  
centers for all applications excluding  
commercial fire systems.  
To enable the Fire Trouble Resound  
feature at 12:00 PM, program a 61 in  
Area 6’s Silent Alarm Relay entry.  
To enable the Fire Trouble Resound  
feature at 12:00 AM, program a 62 in  
Area 6’s Silent Alarm Relay entry.  
Battery Trouble  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Note:  
Programming a value other than 0, 61, or 62  
enables the Fire Trouble Resound feature at  
12:00 AM.  
Activates when battery voltage falls below 85% of  
capacity (12.1 VDC) for a fully charged (13.8 VDC)  
battery, or when the battery is in a missing  
condition. This relay automatically resets when  
battery power is restored.  
Beginning in Firmware version 6.30 and  
higher, a Fire Trouble Resound prompt  
was added to Section 6.7 Miscellaneous.  
This prompt operates as described.  
Use this relay as an option to create  
audible annunciation using the command  
centers for all applications excluding  
commercial fire systems.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Programming Tip #5:  
Perimeter Armed Relay was added to  
firmware versions 6.20 and later. This  
feature, when enabled, turns the Fail to  
Close Relay function into a Perimeter  
Armed Relay function.  
Phone Fail  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
To switch the Fail to Close Relay into a  
Perimeter Armed Relay function, program  
a 63 in Area 7’s Silent Alarm Relay entry.  
Then, program a relay number into the  
appropriate area you wish to activate when  
the area becomes Perimeter Armed  
(COMMAND 2, COMMAND 3, or  
Activates when a telephone line failure occurs. A  
time must be entered in Ph Supv Time (see Section  
2.2 Phone Parameters) for this relay to activate. This  
relay automatically resets upon restoral of the phone  
line(s).  
COMMAND 8). See Programming Tip #2  
for additional information.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 2.0 9000MAIN  
EN | 72  
Summary Fire Tbl  
Default: Blank  
Comm Fail  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
This relay activates when any Fire point in the  
control panel is in trouble, or if a Fire Supervision  
point is missing. This relay provides a steady output  
until all Fire points restore to a normal condition.  
This relay activates when a control panel is unable  
to communicate a report after making ten attempts  
to each routing destination. At the same time, COMM  
FAIL RT ##displays at the command center. This  
relay automatically resets when a report is sent  
successfully.  
Summary SupFire  
Default:  
Blank  
Use this relay to report primary digital  
report failure to an alternate  
communication device.  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Activates when any Fire Supervisory point in the  
control panel is in a supervisory condition (off  
normal). This relay provides a steady output until all  
Fire Supervisory points are restored to a normal  
condition.  
Log % Full  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Summary Trouble  
Enter the number of the relay that activates when  
the log reaches the programmed percentage of its  
capacity as programmed in RAM Parameters  
program item Log % Full. This relay provides a  
steady output until a Get Log and Set Pointer is  
performed from the RPS.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Activates when any Non-fire point in the control  
panel is in a trouble condition. This relay provides a  
steady output until the user at the command center  
acknowledges the trouble.  
Summary Fire  
Default:  
Blank  
Summary SupBurg  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Default:  
Blank  
Enter the number of the relay that activates when  
any Fire point in the system (P## Type 0, P## Fire  
Yes) goes into alarm. This relay provides a steady  
output until all Fire points in the system are returned  
to normal.  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Activates when any Non-fire Supervisory point in  
the control panel is in a supervisory condition, or if a  
Supervisory Burg point is missing. This relay  
provides a steady output until it is acknowledged at  
the command center.  
Summary Alarm  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 128 (1 to 64 for D7412G),  
A, B, or C  
Enter the relay’s number that activates when a Non-  
fire point goes into alarm. This relay provides a  
steady output until the alarm is acknowledged by a  
valid passcode then cleared from alarm memory  
with an acknowledgment at the command center.  
This relay does not activate for silent  
alarms.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 RADXUSR1/RADXUSR2  
EN | 73  
3.0 RADXUSR1/RADXUSR2  
When using the Add/Change User function  
at the command center, the authority levels  
and the changes made affect the master  
user’s passcode and the entire group’s  
token/cards.  
3.1  
Passcode/Token Worksheet  
These programming items assign user groups 001 to  
249 a passcode, area assignment by authority level,  
and a User Group Window.  
When using the ACCESS CTL LVL function  
at the command center, the whole group is  
affected by whether the level is on or off for  
access control functions only.  
0101  
Two handlers in the D5200 Programmer are  
01  
used to program the users. RADXUSR1  
Handler programs users 000 to 124.  
RADXUSR2 programs users 125 to 249  
(D9412G only).  
0101  
When using the DELETE USER? function,  
the whole group is deleted. There is no  
means to delete each user within the group  
individually. It is recommended that you use  
the ADD/CHG USER? function to change a  
user token/card instead of deleting the  
whole group.  
3.1.1 User Groups  
For the D9412G, there are 249 groups (99 groups for  
the D7412G) consisting of one user with a passcode  
and token, (master) and three users with  
tokens/cards but not a passcode (sub-user). All users  
in the group share the same authority level as the  
master user.  
3.1.5 User Name  
Each user group can be assigned one U### Name.  
This name is logged and reported to the central  
station for all the users in the group. The user ID is  
used to differentiate which user’s token/card was  
executed.  
3.1.2 Passcodes  
Only the master user is assigned a passcode. The  
passcode can be three to six digits. Entering three  
digits in User ### chooses the master user.  
Programming the U### Passcode assigns a  
passcode to the master user. Sub-users cannot use  
the passcode. While the system allows tokens/cards  
to be added to USER 0 (service passcode), the  
tokens/cards do not function because the service  
passcode uses Authority Level 15.  
Beginning with v6.30, when using a D1260  
Command Center, User 249 text is used  
for contact information text (such as  
telephone numbers). If a D1260 is installed  
on the system, do not use User 249 for  
user ID information.  
3.1.3 User Group Window  
3.1.6 Tokens/Cards  
Use U### User Group to enable/disable the  
U### Passcode for up to eight different time  
periods throughout the day. Assign the number (1 to  
8) programmed in U### User Group to a User  
Windows #. If the user is outside a window,  
COMMAND DISABLEDappears on the command  
center after the user enters the passcode and presses  
[ENTER].  
The master user assigned the passcode can also be  
assigned a token/card. This is done by programming  
the U### Mstr Site and U### Mstr C/D.  
Three more token/cards are assigned to the user  
group for sub-users using the U### SU# Site and  
U### SU# C/D.  
3.1.7 Reporting and Logging  
Modem Format must be Yes for the following  
reports to the central station. Regardless of the  
reporting format, they log and print at the local  
printer as shown. Each sub-user is identified by the  
master user’s three-digit number plus an extension of  
0, 1, 2, or 3. These numbers are called Sub-user ID  
Codes.  
This window does not affect tokens/cards, it  
only affects the passcode of the master  
user.  
3.1.4 Authority Level by Area  
A user group is assigned an authority level of 1  
through 14 for each area using the U### Area #  
Auth prompt. The authority level can be different  
for each area. Not programming an authority level  
for an area is indicated by the NOT AUTHORIZED  
display on the command center.  
Figure 3 shows all the users for User Group 122 as  
they would appear.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 RADXUSR1/RADXUSR2  
EN | 74  
Figure 3: User Group 122 Example  
Master User:  
ID 122.  
1
CRD ID 122-0  
Sub User -1: ID 122-1  
CRD ID 122-1  
2
Sub User -2: ID 122-2.  
CRD ID 122-2  
Sub User -3: ID 122-3.  
CRD ID 122-3  
1 - User passcode  
2 - User token/card  
0101  
01  
0101  
In reporting systems using modem format, all three digits of the User ID Code are transmitted to the  
central station with appropriate reports. Central station automation computer systems may only accept  
Zonex and COMEX style User Ids. See Point/User Flag in Section 2.1 Phone.  
In BFSK, only one number is transmitted. This number represents a group of ten users as shown in Table 28.  
Users 100 through 249 do not report in BFSK format.  
Table 28: BSFK User Code Report  
User Code User Code User Code User Code User Code User Code User Code User Code User Code User Code  
000 to 009 010 to 019 020 to 029 030 to 039 040 to 049 050 to 059 060 to 069 070 to 079 080 to 089 090 to 099  
BFSK  
Report  
0
BFSK  
Report  
1
BFSK  
Report  
2
BFSK  
Report  
3
BFSK  
Report  
4
BFSK  
Report  
5
BFSK  
Report  
6
BFSK  
Report  
7
BFSK  
Report  
8
BFSK  
Report  
9
User ###  
U### Passcode  
Default: See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Three to six digits ( 0 to 9)  
Default:  
001  
Selection: 000 or 001 to 249 (001 to 099 for the  
D7412G)  
Enter three to six digits to enable a passcode for the  
master user in this group.  
Enter the User number you are programming.  
0101  
0101  
User 000 is the Service Authority Level  
(Level 15). You cannot change the  
User I.D.000 is the Service Passcode. The  
default Service Passcode is 123.  
01  
01  
0101  
0101  
programming for user 000.  
The programmer does not allow you to  
enter any passcode number that could  
conflict with a duress passcode. If Duress  
Type is a 1, passcodes within a range of 1  
for existing passcodes cannot be entered.  
This rule applies even if duress is disabled.  
For example, once a passcode of 654321  
is entered, 654322, 654323, 654320,  
and 654329 cannot be entered.  
Only the Service Authority Level (User  
000) can delete User 000. When a user  
other than User 000 tries to delete the  
passcode for User 000, the command  
center displays NOT IN USE.  
User 000 cannot be added/changed at the  
command center whether it exists or not.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 RADXUSR1/RADXUSR2  
EN | 75  
A silence bell authority is built into all  
authority levels, even if they are the default  
U### Name  
and none of the available programmable  
functions are enabled. A user passcode  
can silence a Fire/Burg bell as long as any  
authority level is assigned to the area  
where the bell can be silenced.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Sixteen alphanumeric characters  
Enter Alphabetic-characters A to Z in capital letters  
Period (.), comma (,), percent (%), parentheses [()],  
equal (=), greater/less than (<>), exclamation (!),  
braces ({}), apostrophe (’), carat (^), grave accent (`),  
tilde (~), semi-colon (;), and colon (:) are not  
allowed.  
U### User Group  
Default: Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 8  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text for this user  
group.  
Use this parameter to create a group of up to 249  
users (99 for the D7412G) whose combinations can  
be enabled/disabled using an automatic user  
window. This is the number entered into the W#  
User Group for any active W# User Window.  
Multiple windows can be programmed for one user  
group (up to eight) within one 24-hour period. For  
example, if User Group 1 has a window running  
from 8:00 AM (start time) to 4:00 PM (stop time),  
the users for that group may use their passcodes only  
between that time. Between 4:00 PM that day and  
8:00 AM the next day, the users may not use their  
passcodes.  
Programming this group with a  
departmental, team, or function name  
identifies all the users in this group in a  
function related manner, such as  
ENGINEERING.  
Card Data Format  
The D9412G/D7412G and D9210B Controller  
comply with the 26-BIT Wiegand card data format.  
In essence, the format consists of 26 bits (3.2 bytes)  
of data. The first bit is used for the even parity. The  
next 8 bits (first byte) is used for the U### Site  
Code. The next 16 bits (second and third byte) are  
used for the U### Card Data. The last bit is used  
for the odd parity.  
0101  
01  
To enable this user’s passcode at all times,  
leave U### User Group blank.  
0101  
As long as the reader and tokens/cards you are using  
are 26-BIT Wiegand compatible, they function with  
this system.  
User Group Window times cannot be changed from  
the command center. Once a window is assigned to  
a user group, the users in that group rely on the  
window to be active (within the start and stop times)  
for their passcodes to function. The only way to  
disable the window is by reprogramming the control  
panel from the D5200 or RAM.  
Use only the readers identified as being compatible  
with the D9210B door control module. Information  
on these readers can be found in the D9210B O/I  
Manual.  
For more information, see the Security Industry  
Association (SIA) Access Control 26-BIT Wiegand  
Reader Interface Standard.  
U### Area 1 [through Area 8] Auth  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: 1 to 14 or Blank  
U### Mstr Site  
Assign an authority level to the user for this area.  
Blank means the user has no authority in this area.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: 000 = (0) to 254 or Blank (255)  
Master User ### Site Data  
Enter the first three decimal numbers on the back of  
the token/card. This is the first byte (bits 2 through  
9) of data for a 26-bit Wiegand card. This is called  
the site number. Tokens/cards with a site code of  
255 are not compatible with the D9412G/D7412G  
Control Panels.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 3.0 RADXUSR1/RADXUSR2  
EN | 76  
0101  
01  
0101  
U### SU1 through SU3 C/D  
Default: Blank  
Converting hexadecimal to decimal: If  
your card label contains letters as well as  
numbers, the number is hexadecimal.*  
Convert the hexadecimal number to  
decimal using your calculator. If you cannot  
convert in this way, use the reader and the  
Add/Chg User? Function to add the  
tokens/cards.  
Selection: 00000 = (0) to 655354 or Blank  
(65535)  
Sub-users one through three card data.  
Perform the following test to confirm you  
can convert properly:  
Use 319EB0 as the hexadecimal number.  
On your calculator, press [HEX]. Enter all  
the hexadecimal characters into the  
calculator. Press [DEC] and your  
hexadecimal characters convert to the  
following eight digits: 03251888. The site  
number is 032. Enter it in U### Mstr  
Site. Your card data is 51888. Enter it into  
U### Mstr C/D.  
*
A hexadecimal number can contain all  
numerals. If the code does not work try  
converting the number from  
hexadecimal to decimal.  
Always tag your tokens before adding  
them to the system so you do not mix them  
up. Use the CRD ID ###-# number to  
index them.  
U### Mstr C/D  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: 00000 = (0) to 65534 or Blank (65535)  
Master User ### Card Data  
Enter the remaining five decimal numbers on the  
back of the token/card. This is the second and third  
byte (bits 10 through 25) of data for a 26-bit  
Wiegand card. This is called the card data.  
You must program U### Mstr Site before  
programming this prompt.  
U### SU1 through SU3 Site  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: 000 = (0) to 254 or Blank (255)  
Sub-users one through three Site Data.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 77  
The NEW RECORD program contains default  
entries and descriptions that match RPS defaults for  
point indexes. See the D9412G/D7412G Program  
Record Sheet for defaults.  
4.0 RADXPNTS  
4.1  
Point Index  
Use this programming module to construct  
personality types for points used in the system. The  
Index numbers are used in Point Assignments. Each  
unique point index number determines the control  
panel’s responses to specific conditions occurring on  
the Protective points.  
Point Index  
Default:  
1
Selection: 1 to 31  
The number of the point personality you are  
programming. You can define up to 31 individual  
personalities.  
P## Type  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: 0 to 9  
P ##  
Type  
Description  
0
24-hour: A 24-hour point is not turned on and off from a command center. 24-hour points are  
armed all the time, and can be used for fire protection (see the P ## Fire Point prompt in Section  
4.1.1 Point Responses), panic, medical, and police alerts.  
24-hour points can be programmed as bypassable. Consider the application carefully before using  
the bypassable option. Bypassable 24-hour points should be programmed to Buzz on Fault.  
When a 24-hour point is bypassed, send the report as it occurs. If the area contains all 24-hour  
points, the area is never armed or disarmed. A Deferred Bypass Report is not sent.  
24-hour protection for fire doors, roof hatches, and so on. Instead of programming this type of  
protection as a 24-hour point, consider using a Perimeter point type with a Point Response of 9 to E.  
24-hour points do not show faults when an arming function is entered, but Perimeter points do.  
When programming this type of protection, consider also using the Buzz on Fault and Local While  
Disarmed options.  
1
Perimeter: Perimeter points are armed with all Arming functions. Points programmed as perimeter  
can also be armed as a group (using Perimeter-Arming functions) separately from points  
programmed as interior. This lets the user partially arm the system to establish Perimeter protection  
while occupying the interior of the protected premises.  
Perimeter points can be programmed to initiate entry delay time. If the point initiates entry delay, it  
can also initiate an entry tone.  
When a Perimeter point is programmed for entry delay, entry delay time is always provided. If the  
area is in entry delay when a second Perimeter point trips, the control panel compares the remaining  
entry delay time to the time programmed for the second Perimeter point. If the second Perimeter  
point’s entry delay time is less than the remaining time, it shortens the entry delay time.  
Perimeter points programmed for an instant point response, generate an alarm immediately when  
tripped, even during entry or exit delay.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 78  
P ##  
Description  
Type  
Selection  
2
Interior: Interior points are armed only by master arming the area. They are NOT armed when  
using Perimeter Arming functions. These points are typically used to monitor interior detection  
devices such as interior doors, motion detectors, photoelectric beams, and carpet mats.  
Instant Interior Points: Interior points are usually programmed for an instant alarm (see Section  
4.1.1 Point Responses). Points programmed for instant alarms generate alarms immediately, even  
during entry or exit delay.  
Delayed Interior Points: Interior points can be programmed for a delayed point response. A  
delayed response means that if the point is tripped while the area is armed, it initiates entry delay. It  
does not generate an alarm until entry delay expires.  
When an Interior point is programmed for entry delay, entry delay time is always provided. If the  
area is in entry delay when the Interior point trips, the control panel compares the remaining entry  
delay time to the time programmed for the Interior point. If the Interior point’s entry delay time is  
less than the remaining time, it shortens the entry delay time.  
Delayed points can also initiate an entry tone at the command center (see the P## Ent Tone Off  
prompt in Section 4.1.1 Point Responses).  
In some cases, you may need to create an Interior point that causes an instant alarm only if entry  
delay protection is not tripped first. Use Interior Follower to create this type of protection.  
Interior Follower: Interior Follower points are armed only by master arming the area. They are  
NOT armed when using Perimeter-Arming functions.  
3
An Interior Follower point does not create an alarm if it trips while the area is in entry delay. An  
Interior Follower does not change the amount of remaining entry delay time.  
If no entry delay is in effect when the Interior Follower trips, it creates an instant alarm.  
You must program a delayed Point Response (4, 5, 6, 7, or 8) for an Interior Follower point. The  
control panel ignores the entry in P## Entry Delay for an Interior Follower point.  
Note:  
It may be necessary to increase the debounce count for Interior Follower points to prevent Interior Follower  
points from going into alarm before the control panel recognizes that a Perimeter Delay point was faulted.  
Program the Interior Follower’s debounce for one number higher than the debounce count on Perimeter delay  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 79  
P ##  
Type  
Description  
4*  
Keyswitch Maintained: Program Point Response as 1. Do not connect initiating devices to a  
Keyswitch point.  
Normal:  
Short:  
The area is disarmed.  
When this point changes from normal to open, the area arms.  
Open:  
A short is a trouble when the area is disarmed. A short is an alarm when the area is  
armed. When this point changes from shorted to normal or open, it restores.  
Program Point Response as 2, the point responds as follows:  
Normal:  
Open:  
Short:  
When this point changes from open to normal, the area arms.  
The area is disarmed.  
A short is a trouble when the area is disarmed. A short is an alarm when the area is  
armed. When this point changes from shorted to normal or open, it restores.  
Trouble and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local While Disarmed is Yes.  
Alarm and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local While Armed is Yes.  
5*  
Keyswitch Momentary: Used for area arming and disarming. Point Response must be  
programmed 1. Do not connect initiating devices to a Keyswitch point.  
When this point momentarily changes from normal to shorted to normal, it toggles  
the armed state of the area.  
NSN:  
Open:  
An open is a trouble while the point is disarmed. An open is an alarm while the  
point is armed.  
When this point changes from open to normal, it restores.  
Trouble and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local Disarmed is Yes.  
6*  
Open/Close Point: Used for point arming and disarming. Point Response must be programmed 1.  
Local bells are silenced through the command center.  
Normal:  
Open:  
Short:  
The point is armed and sends a Point Closing Report. A Point Closing Report is not  
sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
An open is an alarm when the point is armed. An open is a trouble when the point  
is disarmed. Alarm and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local Disarmed is Yes.  
The point is disarmed and sends a Point Opening Report. A Point Opening Report  
is not sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
* Keyswitch Points. Special rules apply to points used for Keyswitch functions. These special point types do not respond  
the same way to the point response entry as Point Types 1, 2, and 3. Responses for keyswitch point types are described in  
Section 4.1.1 Point Responses.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 80  
P ##  
Description  
Type  
Selection  
7*  
8*  
9*  
D279 (O/C Non-Priority): The D279 provides point arming and disarming independent of the area  
arm state. A non-priority D279 point arm state does not affect the area arm state. Point Response  
must be programmed 1. Local bells are silenced through the command center. For bell control at the  
D279, use P## Type 8.  
Cut the W1 jumper on the D279 to send Point Opening and Point Closing Reports. If the D279’s  
W1 jumper is not cut, no Open or Close Report is sent, regardless of control panel programming.  
Normal:  
Open:  
Short:  
The point is armed and sends a Point Closing Report. Point Closing Report is not  
sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
The point is disarmed and sends a Point Opening Report. A Point Opening Report  
is not sent if Local Armed is Yes.  
A short is an alarm when the point is armed. A short is a trouble when the point is  
disarmed. Alarm and Restoral Reports are not sent if Local Disarmed is Yes.  
D279 (O/C Priority): The D279 provides point arming and disarming independent of the area arm  
state. A priority D279 point must be armed before an area can be armed. Program Point Response  
as 2.  
Cut the W1 jumper on the D279 to send area Opening and Closing Reports as programmed in Area  
Parameters and to provide bell control. If the D279’s W1 jumper is NOT cut then no Area Open or  
Area Close Report is sent, and alarm bells can only be silenced from a command center, no matter  
how the control panel is programmed.  
Normal:  
Open:  
When this point changes from open to normal, the area arms.  
The area is disarmed. The alarm bell silences if an alarm occurred while the area  
was armed.  
Short:  
A short is a trouble while the area is disarmed. A short is an alarm while the area is  
armed. When this point changes from shorted to normal or open, it restores.  
Easikey: This point is programmed for access. Program Point Response as 1. If the system is  
Master Armed or Perimeter Armed (with or without delays), presenting a valid token to the Easikey  
reader shorts the point and disarms its assigned area. Presenting a valid token in a Disarmed state  
does not clear trouble or alarm memory or rearm the area.  
* Keyswitch Points. Special rules apply to points used for Keyswitch functions. These special point types do not respond  
the same way to the point response entry as Point Types 1, 2, and 3. Responses for keyswitch point types are described in  
Section 4.1.1 Point Responses.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 81  
4.1.1 Point Responses  
Applications for Point Responses 9, D,  
and E:  
Characteristics of a Fire Point:  
Reporting: When a group of events occur,  
the control panel routes and prints out Fire  
Reports first.  
Combine Point Responses 9, D, and E with  
Perimeter point types to create more flexible  
24-hour protection. Unlike 24-hour points, a  
faulted Perimeter point with a Point  
Response of D and E displays at the  
command center when arming. Like a 24-  
hour point, a point programmed this way can  
generate alarms whether the area is armed  
or disarmed.  
Visual Annunciation: Fire troubles continue  
to scroll until the trouble is cleared. Once  
acknowledged, FIRE TROUBLEscrolls to  
let the end user know that a Fire point, or  
group of Fire points, is still in trouble. Panel-  
Wide Relays, Summary Fire, and  
Summary Fire Tbl activate if a relay is  
assigned when any Fire point goes into  
alarm or is in trouble.  
Combining Point Response 9 with the Local  
While Disarmed feature provides off-site  
reporting when the area is armed, but only  
local alarm annunciation when the area is  
disarmed.  
Audible Annunciation: A Fire point  
activates the A# Fire Bell relay  
programmed in Relay Parameters. The  
amount of time and pattern of the relay  
activation is programmed by area in Bell  
Parameters, A# Fire Time, and A# Fire  
Pat.  
Combining Point Response 9 with the Local  
While Armed feature provides off-site  
reporting when the area is disarmed, but  
only local alarm annunciation when the area  
is armed.  
Supervisory: A Fire point can send a Fire  
Supervisory Report and activate the  
Summary Fire, Sup and Summary Fire  
Tbl, Panel-Wide Relays with a P##  
Response of 8-9-A-B-C.  
Point Response E: Use this for Zonex/Asic  
motion detectors. The control panel can  
report troubles while Master Armed.  
Point Response F: Does not sound at local  
command centers but activates RlyResp  
Type 1 and command center faults. To  
annunciate the off-normal state at a  
command center, program Disp as Dvc as  
Yes and/or BuzzOn Fault as 1 or 2. This  
point response does not generate alarms or  
activate an alarm relay.  
Alarm Verification: A Fire point can delay  
an alarm by the time programmed in A#  
Verify Time in the Area Parameters.  
Combined with A# Resettable, a Fire point  
also resets the electrical circuit for the verify  
time amount.  
Reset Sensor: A fire device that requires  
resetting can be manually reset using the  
reset sensor relay for the area it is assigned  
to.  
Point Response 8, 9, A, B, and C provide  
supervisory (24-hour) reporting.  
Fire Walk: Use the Fire Walk function to  
test Fire points in the system.  
To provide an audible tone for a restored  
Fire Supervisory point, use P## RlyResp  
Type 1 and connect to a graphic  
annunciator.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 82  
P## Pt Response  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: 0 to F  
Controlled (Non-24-Hour Points)  
Point Response  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
I I I I D D I I D I I I I I T  
I I I I I I D D D I I I I I I  
Armed  
Armed  
Open  
Short  
T
T
T
I I T I  
I T I  
T
Disarmed Open  
Disarmed Short  
T T  
T
I
24-Hour Points  
Point Response  
Open  
0
I
1
T
I
2
I
3
T
T
4
I
5
6
I
7
8
S
9
T
S
A
S
B
S
C
S
D
E
F
T
Short  
I
T
T
T
S
Key:  
I = Instant alarm  
D = Delayed alarm  
T = Trouble  
0101  
0101  
001  
When programming the point response  
for Inovonics Wireless Transmitters,  
regardless of how the transmitter is  
programmed, the D8125INV Wireless  
Interface always sends the off-normal  
S = Supervisory  
state to the control panel as a short and a  
tamper condition as an open. As a result,  
typical point responses for the Inovonics  
transmitters would include 0, 1, 6, 7, and  
E for Controlled points, and 0 and 1 for  
24-hour Burg points. When programming  
a transmitter as a Fire point, a Point  
Blank = Audible/visual response  
Example of Controlled point:  
Point Type = 1  
Point Response = 8  
Perimeter point with delayed alarm response when  
armed (opened or shorted) and no response when  
disarmed.  
Response of 1 is recommended.  
Note:  
Example of 24-hour point:  
Point Type = 0  
Wireless transmitters are NOT UL Listed with  
the D9412G/D7412G in fire or burglary  
applications. At present, Inovonics Wireless  
Transmitters, when used with the D8125INV  
Wireless Interface on a 9000 Series Control  
Panel, are not UL Listed for use with fire or  
burglary applications.  
Point Response = 8  
24-hour point with supervisory response when open  
and a trouble response when shorted.  
With Supervisory Pt Response (S =  
Supervisory), the BFSK format does not  
transmit fire supervisory or Non-fire  
Supervisory Events. Modem format must  
be used with Supervisory Point  
Responses.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 83  
0101  
01  
0101  
P## Entry Delay  
Entry Tone can also be turned off when  
programming your CC Entry Tone, in  
Section 2.10 Command Center, which  
allows you to manage the tone by  
command center.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: 5 seconds to 600 seconds  
Use this option to enter the amount of entry delay  
time that a user has after faulting a Controlled point  
(P## Type 1, 2, 3) with a delayed response (D)  
(P## Pt Response) of 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8. DISARM NOW  
displays for the duration of the time programmed  
when the point is faulted in the delay condition.  
You may want to disable the entry tone in  
high security applications where you do  
not want to annunciate entry delay.  
P## Silent Bell  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
0101  
Beginning with firmware revision 6.30  
0101  
and higher, the D1255 alternates  
between DISARM NOWand the point text  
of the point that caused the area to go  
into entry delay.  
001  
Yes  
Activate the Silent Alarm relay when  
this point goes into alarm. Command  
centers do not sound the alarm tone  
for Non-fire points.  
If this time expires before disarming, or if the point  
is faulted to an instant response (I), an alarm occurs.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Make entries in 5 second increments. The  
programmer does not allow off-increment  
entries.  
No  
Activate either the Fire Bell relay or  
Alarm Bell relay and sound the alarm  
tone at command centers when this  
point goes into alarm. If this is a Fire  
point, it activates the Fire Bell relay  
programmed in Relay Parameters.  
Otherwise, it activates the Alarm Bell  
relay. The amount of time and pattern  
of the relay activation is programmed  
by area in Bell Parameters.  
If another Perimeter or Interior Follower  
Delay point trips while the area is already  
in entry delay, the control panel adjusts the  
delay time to the Delay point with the least  
amount of delay time.  
Use P## Type 3 Interior Follower to  
program points that do not go into instant  
alarm the user must fault in order to get to  
the command center and disarm during  
the entry or exit delay period.  
If you want this point to eventually ring the  
bell because the message failed to reach  
the central station receiver, program P##  
Audible After 2 Failures as Yes.  
P## Ent Tone Off  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
P## Ring Til Rst  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
Disable entry delay tone when this  
point is faulted to the delay response.  
Yes  
The relay programmed to provide fire  
alarm output for this point cannot be  
de-activated until the point restores to  
normal.  
No  
A tone sounds at command centers  
when this point initiates entry delay.  
This option enables/disables the entry delay warning  
tone for this point.  
No  
The relay programmed to provide fire  
alarm output for this point can be de-  
activated before the point restores to  
normal.  
Do not set points to No if they are actually  
used to notify the user to disarm the  
system. The possibility of false alarms  
increases if the entry delay warning is not  
used.  
Use this option to determine if the bell continues to  
ring until the Fire Bell time expires. The point  
returns to a normal condition when the user  
acknowledges the alarm to silence the bell.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 84  
If the point restores and the fire alarm is  
not silenced from the command center,  
the fire alarm output continues until Fire  
Bell time expires. If the point does not  
restore, the fire alarm output continues  
even after bell time expires.  
To prevent the command center alarm tone  
and the A# Burg Alarm bell from sounding,  
this point needs P## Silence Bell  
programmed as Yes.  
0101  
01  
0101  
ALARM SILENCEDdisplays at the  
command center if this Invisible point  
causes a bell to ring upon an alarm and a  
valid passcode is entered.  
\
Use this option for fire applications to meet  
the requirement that audible alarms cannot  
be silenced until the fault condition clears  
or the Fire Bell time expires.  
P## Audible After 2 Failures  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
A# Burg Alarm relay activates after two  
failed attempts.  
No  
P## Silent points do not cause the A#  
Burg Alarm relay to activate even if the  
report does not get to the central  
station receiver.  
Use this option for reporting Non-fire points  
programmed as P## Silent to eventually cause the  
alarm bell to ring if the control panel fails to report  
the Alarm Event at the end of two failed attempts to  
the remote central station receiver.  
0101  
When a point that is programmed for P##  
01  
Silent Bell is faulted, the timer for the A#  
Burg Time starts, even though the bell is  
not yet ringing. It can take up to 3 minutes  
before the second attempt fails. Ensure A#  
Burg Time is programmed to provide the  
amount of bell time you need, minus the 3  
minutes it can take before the bell actually  
begins to ring.  
0101  
P## Invisible Pt  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
Command centers do not display  
alarm activity from this point.  
No  
Activity from this point is visible at the  
command centers.  
Use this option to determine whether the point  
appears in the command center display upon an  
Alarm condition. For LED command centers, the  
LED does not illuminate upon an alarm condition.  
Point text appears and annunciation is made for  
Invisible points programmed for a trouble condition  
in point response.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 85  
P## Buzz On Fault  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 3  
Selection  
Operation for Controlled Points  
(Point Types 1, 2, and 3)  
Operation for 24-hour Points  
(Point Type 0)  
Blank  
The point only generates a buzz at the command Same  
center if it goes into the trouble condition  
indicated in the P## Point Response.  
1
The point generates a Buzz Until Restore at the  
command center for any fault condition while the  
point is disarmed. The buzz continues until the  
point restores and the user acknowledges the  
condition using a passcode or COMMAND 4.  
The point must be normal before the user can  
silence the buzz.  
The point generates a Buzz Until Restore at the  
command center for any fault condition regardless  
of the armed state. The buzz continues until the  
point restores and the user acknowledges the  
condition using a passcode or COMMAND 4.  
The point must be normal before the user can  
silence the buzz.  
2
3
The point generates a buzz at the command  
center for any fault condition when the point is  
disarmed. The point does not need to be normal  
before the user can silence the buzz.  
The point generates a buzz at the command  
center for any fault condition regardless of the armed  
state. The point does not need to be normal  
before the user can silence the buzz.  
The point generates a buzz at the command  
center for any fault condition when the area is  
disarmed. The user cannot silence this buzz, but  
it silences automatically when the point is  
restored. If the fault condition results in a trouble  
response, the command center continues to buzz  
even after the user acknowledges the condition if  
the fault is still present.  
The point generates a buzz at the command  
center for any fault condition regardless of the  
armed state. The user cannot silence this buzz,  
but it silences automatically when the point is  
restored. If the fault condition results in a trouble  
response, the command center continues to buzz  
even after the user acknowledges the condition if  
the fault is still present.  
P## Watch Point  
The buzz does not automatically stop once  
the point is restored when using Option 1 or  
2. The user must acknowledge the buzz  
prior to the buzz stopping. However, when  
using Option 3, the buzz automatically stops  
when the point restores to normal without  
user intervention.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point activates Watch Mode  
responses if it is faulted while the  
control panel is in Watch Mode.  
Do not activate Watch Mode responses  
for this point.  
Points bypassed (by the user, Sked,  
Swinger Bypass, or RAM) do not generate a  
Buzz On Fault condition at the command  
center.  
Use this option to allow a Controlled point to  
generate a watch tone as long as the area is disarmed  
and not being faulted into a trouble or alarm  
condition.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 86  
Use this option to cause the command center to  
P## RlyResp Type  
display CHECK DEVICEonce a point is off normal  
or was acknowledged after going into alarm.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 2  
Use this function for devices with a dry  
contact output which faults a point once  
the device is in a trouble condition.  
Blank  
1
Point state does not affect the operation  
of the corresponding relay.  
Relay Follow Point: The relay  
corresponding with this point activates  
when the point is faulted to any off  
normal condition. The relay  
P## Local While Disarmed  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
automatically resets when the point is  
returned to normal.  
Yes  
No  
Suppress Alarm, Trouble and Restoral*  
Reports from this point while the area  
it is assigned to is disarmed.  
2
Relay Latches: The relay  
corresponding with this point latches  
when the point goes into an alarm  
condition. This relay provides a steady  
output until the alarm is acknowledged  
by a valid passcode then cleared from  
alarm memory with an  
Report events occurring from this  
point while the area is disarmed.  
* Restoral Reports are still transmitted if the alarm,  
trouble, or bypass (by Sked, RAM, or Swinger bypass)  
condition occurred when the area disarmed, and the  
point restored.  
acknowledgment at the command  
center.  
Use this option to allow a Controlled point (P##  
Type 1, 2, 3), to report Alarms, Troubles, and  
Restoral Reports only when the area is armed. This  
prompt does not affect local annunciation.  
Use this option to cause a relay (1 to 127 for  
D9412G; 1 to 64 for D7412G) to respond when a  
corresponding point with the same number (1 to  
127) is faulted. [This requires connecting D8129  
OctoRelays to Zonex Bus 1 and/or Zonex Bus 2  
(D9412G only). See address settings on the back of  
the D9412G/D7412G Program Record Sheet (P/N:  
47488)].  
Local While Disarmed suppresses all  
reports from 24-hour points. Do not use  
P## Type 0 for this prompt. Remember  
that this only works for Disarmed points,  
and a Type 0 is a 24-hour Always Armed  
point. Instead, choose any type other than  
0, and use a point response that reports  
an alarm whether the point is armed or not.  
For instance, P## Type 1 and P##  
Response 9 reports an alarm on an open  
or a short (I) whether the area is armed or  
not.  
Point 128 is reserved for other use than an  
actual point. Only the first 127 points can  
have an associated relay. Relays are not  
available for Points 129 to 247.  
Do not use the Chg Relays? function to  
toggle relays reserved for special  
functions. Special function relays are Area  
and Panel Wide Relay functions as well as  
relays assigned to CC Entr Key Rly and  
P## RlyResp Type.  
Local While Disarmed affects Keyswitch  
points. This prompt suppresses keyswitch  
(troubles/restorals) and D279  
(alarms/troubles/restorals). Do not use this  
parameter for these applications.  
P## Disp as Dvc  
P## Local While Armed  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Display CHECK DEVICEwhen this  
point is off normal.  
Yes  
No  
Suppress Alarm, Trouble and Restoral*  
Reports from this point while the area  
it is assigned to is armed.  
Do not display CHECK DEVICEwhen  
this point is off normal.  
Report events occurring from this  
point while the area is armed.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 87  
* Restoral Reports are still transmitted if the alarm,  
trouble, or bypass (by Sked, RAM, or Swinger bypass)  
condition occurred when the area disarmed, and the  
point restored.  
P## FA Retrnable  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Allows a controlled point (P## Type 1, 2, 3), to  
report Alarms, Troubles, and Restoral Reports only  
when the area is disarmed. This prompt does not  
affect local annunciation.  
Yes  
This point automatically returns to the  
system when it restores to normal.  
No  
This point stays out of the system until  
the area is disarmed.  
Local While Armed suppresses all reports  
from 24-hour points. Do not use P## Type  
0 for this prompt. This only works for  
disarmed points. Type 0 is a 24-hour  
always armed point. Choose any Type  
other than 0, and use a point response  
that reports an alarm whether the point is  
armed or not. For instance, P## Type 1  
and P## Response 9 reports an alarm on  
a trouble or a short whether the area is  
disarmed or not.  
Use this option to allow points that were force  
armed out of the area to return back to the armed  
state once they become normal again without having  
to disarm the system.  
Use on loading dock doors, which must be  
left open until loading is completed. Once  
the loading dock door is closed, the point  
detects any subsequent opening and  
reports an alarm.  
Local While Armed affects Keyswitch  
Points. This prompt suppresses keyswitch  
(alarms/troubles/restorals) and D279  
(opening/closing/troubles/restorals). Do  
not use this parameter for controlled  
points that arm/disarm.  
P## BP Retrnable  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point automatically returns to the  
system when the area is disarmed.  
P## Disable Rst  
This point stays out of the system  
through arming and disarming cycles.  
Default:  
No  
Use this option to return a point that was bypassed,  
force armed, or swinger bypassed back into the  
system once the area this point is assigned to is  
disarmed.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Enable Restoral Reports form this  
point.  
Disable Restoral Reports from this  
point.  
Turn this item to No for Interlock points.  
* Restoral Reports are still transmitted if the alarm,  
trouble, or bypass (by sked, RAM, or Swinger bypass)  
condition occurred when the area disarmed, and the  
point restored.  
When the point cannot return to the  
system through disarming, the point must  
be manually unbypassed using the  
Unbypass?, command center function,  
Sked Functions 4 and 5 or remotely  
unbypassed using RAM.  
Use this option to disable any Restoral Reports from  
this point after it returns to normal from an alarm or  
trouble condition.  
0101  
01  
0101  
For Force Armed points to remain  
bypassed, ensure P## FA Retrnable is  
No.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 88  
P## Bypassable  
P## Swinger Byps  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point can be bypassed and force  
armed.  
Yes  
No  
Enable Swinger Bypass for this point.  
Disable Swinger Bypass for this point.  
This point cannot be bypassed or force  
armed from the command center or  
RAM. However, it can be force armed  
by automatic arming at the end of the  
Closing Window (see the A# Auto  
Close prompt in Section 2.9.5  
Use this option to allow the control panel to  
automatically bypass a point that erroneously reports  
four Alarm or Trouble Events within an hour of the  
first event.  
The control panel reports a Swinger Bypass P###  
upon the fourth report. If the point has a partial  
count (less than four events during an hour), the  
count is reset to zero and three more events are  
required upon the next report before the control  
panel initiates the bypass.  
Open/Close Options) or by a Sked  
programmed to arm the area.  
Use this option to allow this point to be bypassed  
and/or force armed.  
Bypassing a 24-hour point: When a 24-hour point  
or 24-hour Supervisory point is bypassed, 24 HOUR  
BYPASS continuously scrolls at the command  
center. 24 HOUR BYPASSscrolls to indicate a 24-  
hour Non-fire point, P## Fire No is bypassed. FIRE  
BYPASSscrolls to indicate a 24-hour Fire point or a  
Fire Supervisory point is bypassed.  
0101  
P## Bypassable does not need to be  
programmed Yes for swinger bypass to  
work.  
01  
0101  
A Swinger Shunted point returns to the  
system if P## BP Returnable? is Yes. If  
not, return the point to the system as  
described in the application note for P##  
BP Returnable.  
Alternative to a 24-hour Point: For alarm  
capability of a 24-hour point without the  
continuous scrolling, use a Perimeter  
point with a Point Response of 9 to E.  
P## Report Bypass at Occurrence  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
0101  
A point can be bypassed at the command  
01  
center using the BYPASS? function,  
which reports as a Command Bypass.  
When bypassed by Sked Function 3, the  
report is Sked Bypass. When bypassed by  
RAM a RAM Bypass reports after RAM  
disconnects. When swinger shunted, a  
Swinger Shunt is reported. If the point is  
not bypassable, it cannot be bypassed in  
any of the above cases.  
0101  
Yes  
Send a Command Bypass Report at  
the time the point is bypassed.  
No  
Do not send a Command Bypass  
Report at the time the point is  
bypassed.  
This option allows a point to generate a Command  
Bypass Report as soon as a user bypasses the point  
from the command center. This option should be  
enabled for all Bypassable 24-hour points. You may  
also elect to report a bypassed point at the time the  
area is armed. See P## Defer BP Report.  
Programming Bypassable as Yes for  
Cross points may cause missed Cross-  
Point alarms. For example, if Points 1 and  
2 were programmed as Cross points and  
Point 1 was Bypassed or Force Armed,  
Point 2 cannot generate an Alarm Cross  
Point Event. Point 2 may, however,  
generate an Unverified or Alarm Event  
depending on how the point was tripped.  
Be careful when using this feature with  
Cross point applications.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 89  
The Cross point feature is available only on points  
programmed as having an Instant point response.  
Also, Controlled points (Point Types 1, 2 and 3) do  
not follow the Cross point operation (described as  
follows) during entry or exit delay.  
P## Defer BP Report  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
Send a Point Bypass Report with the  
The Cross point option is designed to reduce false  
alarms. To achieve this, points can be programmed  
so the control panel must see an alarm condition  
within a programmed period of time (called Cross  
Point Time) from at least two points within a Cross  
Point Group before Cross Point Alarm Events are  
generated. These points need the Cross point option  
enabled in their corresponding point indexes to be  
able to generate this event. See Section 6.8 Cross Point  
Parameters for additional programming requirements  
to program the Cross Point Timer.  
Closing Report instead of a Command  
Bypass Report when a user bypasses  
the point.  
No  
Do not defer Bypass Reports.  
Use this option to prevent (P## Type 0 to F) points  
that are bypassed by the user (COMMAND  
BYPASS) from occurring until the area is armed.  
Once the area is armed, the bypassed points and any  
point being bypassed during the arming sequence  
report as POINT BYPASS along with the Closing  
Report.  
Cross Point Groups were established in the D9412G  
and D7412G to support the Cross Point function.  
There are 31 Cross Point Groups in the D9412G  
and ten in the D7412G. Each Cross Point Group  
consists of eight points and is identified by the point  
numbers in them (such as, Cross Points 1 to 8, Cross  
Points 9 to 16, and so on).  
0101  
Bypass Reports do not occur when arming  
01  
the area if the Closing Report is  
suppressed by O/C Windows or are not  
reported.  
0101  
Bypass Reports for 24-hour points do not  
report If P## Report Bypass at  
Occurrence and P## Defer Bypass  
Report are both No.  
The Cross point function only applies to  
Alarm conditions. It does not apply to  
Trouble or Supervisory conditions.  
To report the bypass at occurrence and  
when the area is armed, program P##  
Report Bypass at Occurrence and P##  
Defer Bypass Report as Yes. A  
Command Bypass Report is sent as soon  
as it occurs and a Point Bypass Report is  
sent with the Closing Report.  
P## Cross Point  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point is a Cross point.  
This point is not a Cross point.  
The Cross point function is available only  
in Firmware revisions 6.30 and higher.  
Do not use Cross points for Fire points.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 90  
P## Fire Point  
Characteristics of a Fire Point  
Reporting: When a group of events  
occur, the control panel routes and prints  
out Fire Reports first.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This point is a Fire point.  
This point is not a Fire point.  
Visual Annunciation: FIRE TROUBLES  
continues to scroll until the trouble is  
cleared. Once acknowledged, a FIRE  
TROUBLEscroll lets the end user know  
that a Fire point, or group of Fire points, is  
still in trouble. Panel Wide Relays,  
Summary Fire, and Summary Fire Tbl  
activates if a relay is assigned when any  
Fire point goes into alarm or is in trouble.  
Use this option to make a 24-hour point a Fire point.  
This option makes this point the highest priority  
event in the control panel when an alarm occurs for  
both reporting and displaying on the command  
center.  
Audible Annunciation: A Fire point  
activates the A# Fire Bell relay  
programmed in Relay Parameters. The  
amount of time and pattern of the relay  
activation is programmed by area in Bell  
Parameters, A# Fire Time, and A# Fire  
Pat.  
Supervisory: A Fire point can send a Fire  
Supervisory Report and activate the  
Summary Fire Sup and Summary Fire  
Tbl Panel Wide Relays with a P##  
Response of 8-9-A-B-C.  
Alarm Verification: A Fire point can delay  
an alarm by the time programmed in A#  
Verify Time in the Area parameters.  
Reset Sensor: A fire device that requires  
resetting can be manually reset using the  
reset sensor relay for the area where it is  
assigned.  
Fire Walk: Fire points can be tested in the  
system using the Fire Walk Test which  
automatically resets each point for five  
seconds when it is tripped and rings the  
Fire Bell for two seconds.  
You should dedicate a fire annunciation  
device to all your Fire points if they are  
assigned to a single area in a multiple area  
system. Special red command centers and  
annunciators with specific keys for fire  
systems are designed for this type of  
application (D1256 and D1257).  
Do not use the Cross point function for  
Fire points.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 91  
P## Alarm Verify  
When a sensor reset is initiated, the  
control panel does not accept alarms from  
any points with P## Resettable  
programmed as Yes. During the 5-second  
reset time, alarms from these points are  
ignored.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Enable alarm verification on this point.  
Alarm verification points must be  
programmed as resettable.  
Do not mix fire and intrusion devices on  
the same powered loop.  
Disable alarm verification on this  
point.  
4.2  
Point Assignments  
These entries assign point indexes to Points 1 to 127,  
129 to 247 for the D9412G and Points 1 to 75 for the  
D7412G, and assigns the points to the areas. Also  
included in this section are parameters used to set  
the point’s debounce count, BFSK/Relay (for use  
when transmitting in BFSK or assigning relays to  
follow alarms for a group of points), and custom  
command center and report text for each point.  
Use this option only with Fire points to designate  
them for alarm verification.  
When an Alarm Verification point goes into alarm,  
the control panel removes power to all Resettable  
points for the duration programmed in A# Verify  
Time in Section 2.9 Area Parameters. If the point (or  
another Resettable point in the area) is still in alarm,  
or goes back into alarm within 60 seconds after the  
initial verification time reset, an alarm is generated.  
Point Number  
During a Fire Walk Test the reset time is 5  
seconds. The time programmed in A#  
Verify Time is ignored. Use the Cross  
point function for Fire points.  
Default:  
1
Selection: 1 to 127, 129 to 247  
Enter the point number you are programming.  
When transmitting in Modem IIIa2, the three-digit  
point number is reported to the D6500/D6600.  
When transmitting in BFSK, you must assign a zone  
number in BFSK/Relay.  
P## Resettable  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Yes or No  
0101  
01  
Yes  
No  
This point is reset by the Reset Sensor?  
function and during the alarm  
verification sequence.  
Point numbers 128 and 248 are reserved  
for Zonex bus 1 and 2 supervision.  
0101  
This point is not resettable.  
Use this option if this is a Powered point that  
requires interruption of power to reset a latched  
alarm condition. The Resettable point option is  
typically used with smoke detectors and glass break  
detectors.  
When initiated (either through a Fire Walk Test or  
the command center’s Reset Sensor? Function) or  
when the RAM interrupts power to the device for 5  
seconds, Sensor Reset is reported to the central  
station receiver.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 92  
P### Point Index  
P### Debounce  
Default:  
Selection: 1 to 15  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
2
Selection: Blank (00) to 31  
This entry selects one of the 31 P## Index codes  
that define the point’s characteristics and determines  
how the control panel responds to various point  
conditions.  
1
.300 seconds  
2
.600 seconds  
.900 seconds  
1.2 seconds  
1.5 seconds  
1.8 seconds  
2.1 seconds  
2.4 seconds  
2.7 seconds  
3.0 seconds  
3.3 seconds  
3.6 seconds  
3.9 seconds  
4.2 seconds  
4.5 seconds  
3
4
Blank (00) disables the point.  
5
Missing Point Reports occur if a point  
address does not exist for a point assigned  
a point index. Extra Point Events occur if  
more than two devices have the same  
address.  
6
7
8
9
When a POPIT is missing, the control panel  
generates the following responses based  
on the point type:  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
Fire points generate missing trouble  
responses.  
Non-fire 24-hour points generate  
missing alarm responses.  
Non-fire, non 24-hour points generate  
missing alarm responses while armed,  
and trouble responses while disarmed.  
Exception: Non-fire, non-24-hour points  
with a point response of 9 to D  
generate a missing alarm response  
while disarmed.  
The debounce count is the number of times the  
control panel scans a point before initiating an  
alarm. Scan cycles are 300 ms.  
For appropriate settings consult the manufacturer’s  
instructions for the device connected to this point.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Bosch Security Systems recommends an  
entry of two or higher. Interior Follower  
points need a debounce of at least three.  
POPIT modules monitor their sensor loops  
for three conditions: loop normal, loop  
open, and loop shorted. They report these  
three conditions to the control panel. The  
control panel uses point programming to  
interpret the sensor loop information  
reported by the POPITs and to make the  
appropriate system response.  
Door points assigned to D9210B modules  
need a debounce of at least four.  
P### Area Assign  
Default:  
1
Selection: 1 to 8  
The areas are numbered 1 to 8. Select the area  
number to which the point is assigned.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 93  
P### BFSK/Relay  
Two relays can activate when this point  
goes into alarm if the P## Rly Resp Type  
for this point is programmed.  
Default:  
See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: 0 to 9  
Use these codes to activate relays on the  
D8129 OctoRelay (or C8137 Transmitter  
Interface). You can assign the same code  
to several points providing a summary  
zone alarm output. When the point goes  
into alarm, the relay activates. When the  
alarm is acknowledged and is no longer  
scrolling in the command center display,  
the relay resets.  
Use this option to:  
2. Determine the point number reported in BFSK  
when this point is tripped.  
3.  
Activate a relay when the point goes into an  
alarm condition, even if the control panel is  
programmed for Modem reporting as shown in  
Table 29.  
BFSK/Relays do not activate for Fire  
Supervisory or Non-Fire Supervisory  
points.  
P### Point Text  
Default: See Program Record Sheet  
Selection: Up to sixteen alphanumeric  
characters  
Table 29: P### BFSK/Relay Codes/Relays  
Enter alphabetic characters (A to Z) in capital letters.  
Trips Relay  
D8129 on Zonex D8129 on Zonex  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text to describe the  
point. This point text is displayed at command  
centers, if the point is programmed as visible, and  
reported to the D6500/D6600 when transmitting in  
Radionics Modem IIIa2 format (if it is a reporting  
point).  
Bus 2 for  
D9412G*  
Bus 2 for  
D7412G*  
BFSK Code  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Include the point number in custom point text. This  
helps the user when viewing events, initiating  
bypasses, and so on. It can also simplify  
troubleshooting.  
When a D1260 Command Center is  
installed on the system, the point text for  
Points 240 to 247 can be used for Area  
Name Text for Areas 1 to 8, respectively.  
See Table 30:  
* Address setting = 1 (on), 2 (off), 3 (on), 4 (on)  
Local annunciation on the command  
centers and Local Printer reporting and  
the View Log display the actual point  
number (1 to 247), not the BFSK report  
code  
Table 30: Point Text for Points 240 to 247  
0101  
Do not assign a BFSK/Relay to Invisible  
points. To avoid triggering a BFSK/Relay,  
program this prompt as 0.  
Point Text  
Point 240  
Point 241  
Point 242  
Point 243  
Point 244  
Point 245  
Point 246  
Point 247  
Corresponding Area Name Text  
01  
0101  
Area 1  
Area 2  
Area 3  
Area 4  
Area 5  
Area 6  
Area 7  
Area 8  
On the D9412G, do not use relays 73  
through 80 for Area or Panel-Wide Relay  
functions when using BFSK relays. Doing  
so prevents the BFSK relays from  
triggering.  
On the D7412G, do not use relays 9  
through 16 for Area or Panel Wide Relay  
functions when using BFSK relays. Doing  
so prevents BFSK relays from triggering.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 4.0 RADXPNTS  
EN | 94  
4.3  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9  
CMD9 Point Index  
Default: 31  
Selection: Blank (00) to 31  
These entries assign point indexes, BFSK report  
code, BFSK relay that trips, and the text for the  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9 command  
center functions.  
This entry selects one of the 31 P## Index codes  
that define how the control panel reacts when a  
COMMAND 9 is initiated.  
CMD7 Point Index  
Default:  
31  
0101  
01  
0101  
The point index code used for COMMAND  
9 must not be used for any other points on  
the system.  
Selection: Blank (00) to 31  
This entry selects one of the 31 P## Index codes  
that define how the control panel reacts when a  
COMMAND 7 is initiated.  
If the point index for COMMAND 9 has  
Fire points programmed as Yes, this  
causes access control doors to unlock if  
Fire Unlock is also programmed Yes (see  
the D9210B Program Entry Guide).  
0101  
01  
0101  
The point index code used for COMMAND  
7 must not be used for any other points on  
the system.  
CMD9 BFSK/Relay  
Default:  
If the point index for COMMAND 7 has  
Fire points programmed Yes, this causes  
access control doors to unlock if Fire  
Unlock is also programmed Yes (see the  
D9210B Program Entry Guide).  
1
Selection: 0 to 9  
This entry selects one of the digits shown for  
reporting in BFSK or for activating relays 73 to 80  
(on the D9412G) or relays 9 to 16 (for the D7412G)  
when a COMMAND 9 is initiated (see the P###  
BFSK/Relay prompt in Section 4.2 Point Assignments).  
CMD7 BFSK/Relay  
Default:  
1
Selection: 0 to 9  
Selects one of the digits shown for reporting in BFSK  
or for activating relays 73 to 80 (on the D9412G) or  
relays 9 to 16 (for the D7412G) when COMMAND  
7 is initiated (see the P### BFSK/Relay prompt in  
Section 4.2 Point Assignments).  
COMMAND 9 does not activate the  
Summary Fire Alarm relay.  
CMD9 Point Text  
Default:  
[COMMAND][9]  
COMMAND 7 does not activate the  
Summary Fire Alarm relay.  
Selection: Up to sixteen alphanumeric  
characters  
Enter alphabetic characters (A to Z) in capital letters  
CMD7 Point Text  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text to describe the  
point. This point text is displayed at command  
centers (if the point is programmed as visible) and  
reported to the D6500/D6600 when transmitting in  
Radionics’ Modem IIIa2 format (if it is a reporting  
point).  
Default:  
[COMMAND][7]  
Selection: Up to sixteen alphanumeric  
characters  
Enter alphabetic characters A to Z in capital letters  
Enter up to sixteen characters of text to describe the  
point. This point text is displayed at command  
centers (if the point is programmed as visible) and  
reported to the D6500/D6600 when transmitting in  
Radionics’ Modem IIIa2 format (if it is a reporting  
point).  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 95  
5.0 RADXSKED  
Table 31: Window Selections  
5.1  
Windows  
Use this programming module to define the  
windows for Opening and Closing and User Access.  
Selection Sked # Window Sked # Windo  
w
5.1.1 Opening and Closing  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
55  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
Open  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
56  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Close  
Use these windows to set a schedule for disarming  
and arming. The disarming and arming schedules  
provide several independent features:  
Suppress normal Opening and/or Closing  
Reports when A# Disable O/C in Windows is  
programmed Yes.  
Generate a Fail to Open Report if the area is not  
disarmed on schedule when A# Fail To Open  
is programmed Yes.  
Window  
Provide a warning tone and a PLEASE CLOSE  
NOWdisplay at the command center when it is  
time to arm the area.  
Default:  
1
Selection: 1 to 8  
Generate a Fail to Close Report if the area is not  
armed on schedule when A# Fail To Close is  
programmed Yes.  
Enter the window number you want to program.  
W# Sunday  
Automatically arm the area at the end of the  
Closing Window when A# Auto Close is  
programmed Yes.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Activate this window on Sundays.  
Opening and closing schedules can be set up  
independently. For example, if you only want to use  
features provided by Closing Windows, leave times  
blank in the Opening Windows prompts and  
program Closing Window times.  
Do not activate this window on  
Sundays.  
This prompt, and the next six day of the week  
prompts, select the days of the week the Opening  
and/or Closing Windows are active.  
A worksheet is provided at the end of this section for  
your convenience. Following the worksheet are  
examples of how to program Opening and Closing  
Windows for particular applications (see Table 35  
through Table 39.  
Exceptions:  
To prevent the windows from activating on certain  
days of the year, program Xept Holiday Yes, and  
enable at least one Holiday Index. When Xept  
Holiday is Yes, the window executes on the days of  
the week programmed unless the Holiday Index  
designates the date as a holiday.  
About the Program Record Sheet: A column  
labeled Sked # is found on the Program Record Sheet  
provided with the control panel. These numbers  
appear in D6500/D6600 reports and local printer  
reports when the window Begin Time executes.  
If Opening and/or Closing Windows are only  
needed on certain days of the year, do not program  
the windows to execute on any days of the week.  
Instead, program Xept Holiday No and select a  
Holiday Index with the days of the year you want  
the window to be active.  
Window selections 1 through 8 correspond with odd  
numbered Skeds 41 through 55 for Open Window  
and correspond with even numbered Skeds 42  
through 56 for Close Window. For example, when  
the Opening Window for Window 1 executes, a  
Sked 41 Executed Event is generated. See Table 31.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 96  
Start and Open Window Stop time creates a  
local event in the Panel log but does not send  
the Opening Report to the central station.  
W# Monday  
Default:  
No  
Disarming the area after the Open Window Stop  
and the next window’s Open Early Begin time  
(or midnight, whichever comes sooner)  
generates a Late to Open Event.  
Selection: Yes or No  
W# Tuesday  
Default:  
No  
If Disable O/C in Window is Yes: Disarming  
the area generates an Opening Report without  
the early or late modifier, regardless of when the  
area is disarmed.  
Selection: Yes or No  
W# Wednesday  
When you are programming multiple windows  
to activate on a single day, program the  
windows in chronological order. Be careful not  
to program a window’s Open Early Begin time  
for a time that is between any other window’s  
Open Window Start and Open Window Stop  
time.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
W# Thursday  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
0101  
01  
0101  
W# Friday  
Do not program a window to cross the  
midnight boundary.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Disabled windows have a blank begin time. If the  
entry for this prompt is blank, but times are  
programmed for Open Window Start and Open  
Window Stop, the window is disabled.  
W# Saturday  
Default:  
No  
To disable the window, both the hours and minutes  
spaces must be Blank.  
Selection: Yes or No  
W# Open Early Begin  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
Default:  
00:00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
00:00 to 23:59  
Disable/Restart the control panel to activate today’s  
window. If you are programming a window that  
must activate on the same day you are programming  
it, do a disable/restart after programming.  
Open Early Begin: This program item is one of  
three required to create an Opening Window. To  
finish programming an Opening Window, Open  
Window Start and Open Window Stop must be  
programmed.  
W# Open Window Start  
Default:  
00: 00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Use Open Early Begin to set the time the control  
panel looks for an Opening Window. When  
Opening and Closing Reports are enabled,  
disarming the area between midnight and the Open  
Early Begin time generates an Opening Report. In  
addition:  
Enter the time you want the control panel to start  
the Opening Window. The window goes into effect  
at the beginning of the minute.  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
If Disable O/C in Window is Yes: Disarming  
the area between the Open Early Begin and the  
Open Window Start time generates an Early to  
Open Event (if the Open Early Begin time is the  
same as the Open Window Start time, the Early  
to Open Event is not sent).  
This program item is one of three required to create  
an Opening Window. To program an Opening  
Window, Open Early Begin and Open Window  
Stop must also be programmed. See the W# Open  
Early Begin prompt in this section for report  
feature explanations.  
Disarming the area between the Open Window  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 97  
If the area is not disarmed by the time the Open  
Window Stop time expires, the control panel  
generates a Fail to Open Report if enabled in Fail  
To Open.  
W# Open Window Stop  
Default:  
00: 00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Opening Reports generated between the Open  
Window Start time and Open Window Stop time  
can be suppressed by programming Disable O/C in  
Window Yes. See the Open Early Begin prompt  
for other report feature explanations.  
Enter the time you want the control panel to end the  
Opening Window. The window stops at the end of  
the minute.  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
Do not use a time of 23:59 as a window stop time  
unless another window begins on the next day at  
00:00.  
This program item is one of three required to create  
an Opening Window. To program an Opening  
Window, Open Early Begin and Open Window  
Start must also be programmed.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Fail to Open Reports are not sent for  
windows that stop at 23:59.  
Figure 4: Example Opening Window Timeline (using two Opening Windows on same day)  
8
4
1
3
6
9
5
7
2
1 - Areas disarmed between midnight and 6 AM  
generate Opening Reports.  
6 - Areas that are disarmed between 1 PM and 2 PM  
generate Early to Open Reports.  
2 - Areas disarmed between 6 AM and 7 AM  
generate Early to Open Reports.  
3 - If the area is disarmed between 7 AM and 8 AM  
regular Opening Reports are generated. If Disable  
O/C in Window is programmed Yes the Opening  
Report is not transmitted to the central station.  
7 - If the area is disarmed between 2 PM and 3 PM  
regular Opening Reports are generated. If Disable  
O/C in Window is programmed Yes, the Opening  
Report is not transmitted to the central station.  
8 - If the area is not disarmed by 3:01 PM, a Fail to  
Open Event is generated if Fail to Open is  
programmed Yes in Opening and Closing Options.  
9 - If the user disarms the area between 3:01 PM and  
11:59 PM, a Late to Open Event is generated.  
4 - If the area is not disarmed by 8:01 AM, a Fail to  
Open Event is generated if Fail to Open is  
programmed Yes in Opening and Closing Options.  
5 - If the user disarms the area between 8:01 AM and  
12:59, PM a Late to Open Event is generated.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 98  
Table 32: Programming for Two Same Day Opening Windows (see Figure 4)  
Open  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
Start  
07 : 00  
14 : 00  
Stop  
08: 00  
15 : 00  
Stop  
Area(s)  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
06: 00  
13 : 00  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
Do not program a single window to cross the midnight boundary. The window stop time must be later than the  
window start time. To program a window that effectively crosses the midnight boundary, you must program two  
windows.  
For example, to program windows for an area that opens between 11:30 PM and 12:30 AM, five days a week, use  
two windows as shown in Table 33.  
Table 33: Programming to Link Two Days over Midnight  
Open  
Start  
22 : 00 23 : 30  
00 : 00 00 : 00  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Stop  
23 : 59  
00 : 30  
Stop  
Area(s)  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
Yes No  
Yes No  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
Arming the area after the Close Window Stop and  
the next window’s Close Early Begin time (or  
midnight, whichever comes sooner) generates a  
Closing Late Event.  
W# Close Early Begin  
Default: 00: 00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
00:00 to 23:59  
If Disable O/C in Window is No: Disarming  
the area generates a Closing Report without the  
early or late modifier, regardless of when the  
area is armed.  
Close Early Begin: This program item is one of  
three required to create a Closing Window. To finish  
programming a Closing Window, Close Window  
Start and Close Window Stop must be programmed.  
When you are programming multiple windows  
to activate on a single day, program the  
windows in chronological order. Be careful not  
to program a window’s Close Early Begin time  
for a time that is between any other window’s  
Close Window Start and Close Window Stop  
time.  
Use Close Early Begin to set the time that you want  
the control panel to look for a Closing Window.  
When Opening and Closing Reports are enabled,  
arming the area between midnight and the Close  
Early Begin time generates a Closing Report. In  
addition:  
Disabled windows have a blank begin time. If  
the entry for this prompt is blank, but times are  
programmed for Close Window Start and Close  
Window Stop, the window is disabled.  
If Disable O/C in Window is Yes: Arming the  
area between the Close Early Begin time and  
the Close Window Start time generates a  
Closing Early Event (if the Close Early Begin  
time is the same as the Close Window Start  
time, the Closing Early Event is not sent).  
To disable the window, both the hours and  
minutes spaces must be blank.  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make  
entries using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00  
AM is entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as  
14:45).  
Arming the area between the Close Window  
Start and Close Window Stop time creates a  
local event in the Panel log but does not send  
the Closing Report to the central station.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 99  
Enter the time that you want the control panel to  
end the Closing Window. The window stops at the  
end of the minute.  
Disable/Restart the control panel to activate  
today’s window. If you are programming a  
window that needs to activate on the same day  
that you are programming it, do a disable/restart  
after programming.  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
W# Close Window Start  
This program item is one of three required to create  
a Closing Window. To program a Closing Window,  
Close Early Begin and Close Window Start must  
also be programmed.  
Default:  
00: 00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Enter the time that you want the control panel to  
start the Closing Window. The window goes into  
effect at the beginning of the minute.  
If the area is not armed by the time the Close  
Window Stop time expires, the control panel  
generates a Fail to Close Report if enabled in Fail To  
Close.  
00:00 is midnight, 23:59 is 11:59 PM. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
Closing Reports generated between the Close  
Window Start time and Close Window Stop time  
can be suppressed by programming Disable O/C in  
Window Yes. See the W# Close Early Begin  
prompt for other report feature explanations.  
This program item is one of three required to create  
a Closing Window. To program a Closing Window,  
Close Early Begin and Close Window Stop must  
also be programmed.  
Do not use a time of 23:59 as a window stop time  
unless the window continues on the next day at  
00:00. Fail to Close Reports are not sent, and the  
Auto Close feature does not work for windows that  
stop at 23:59.  
If the area is not armed when the Close Window  
Start time comes, a warning tone sounds and  
PLEASE CLOSE NOWdisplays at the command  
center. To temporarily silence the tone, press the  
[ESC] key on the command center. The warning  
tone restarts in 10 minutes if the area is not armed.  
Do not program a single window to cross the  
midnight boundary. The window stop time must be  
later than the window start time. To program a  
window that effectively crosses the midnight  
boundary, you must program two windows.  
See the W# Close Early Begin prompt in this  
section for report feature explanations.  
W# Close Window Stop  
For example, to program windows for an area that  
closes between 11:30 PM and 12:30 AM, five days a  
week, use two windows as shown in Table 34.  
Default:  
00: 00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Table 34: W# Close Window Stop Programming Example  
Open  
Start  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Stop  
Stop  
Area(s)  
22 : 00 23 : 30 23 : 59  
00 : 00 00 : 00 00 : 30  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
Yes No  
Yes No  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 100  
W# Xept Holiday  
W# Holiday 2  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Do not activate this window on  
holidays.  
W# Holiday 3  
Default:  
No  
To use this selection, the window must  
be programmed to activate on at least  
one day of the week and a Holiday  
Index must be enabled.  
Selection: Yes or No  
W# Holiday 4  
A holiday does not prevent this  
window from activating.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
You also use this selection if Opening  
and/or Closing Windows are only  
needed on certain days of the year. Do  
not program the windows to execute  
on any days of the week. Instead,  
program Xept Holiday No, and select  
at least one Holiday Index with the  
days of the year you want the window  
to be active.  
W# Area 1 [through 8]  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Activate the window in the area  
number (#) specified.  
Disable the window in the area  
number (#) specified.  
Determine if the window is disabled on holidays, or  
is active only on holidays.  
Eight separate program items determine whether a  
particular window activates in each of the eight areas  
of the control panel.  
To prevent the windows from activating on certain  
days of the year, program Xept Holiday Yes, and  
enable at least one Holiday Index. When Xept  
Holiday is programmed Yes, the window executes  
on the days of the week programmed unless the date  
is designated as a Holiday by the Holiday Index(es)  
selected.  
Holiday Indexes for O/C Windows  
You can enable up to four Holiday Indexes for use  
with Opening/Closing Windows. Enable at least one  
Holiday Index if W# Xept Holiday is programmed  
Yes for this window, or if you want this window to  
activate only on specific dates. Holidays are  
programmed in Section 5.3 Holiday Indexes.  
W# Holiday 1  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Use Holiday Index 1 with this window.  
Do not use Holiday Index 1 with this  
window.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 101  
Table 35: Opening/Closing Windows Worksheet  
Open  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
Start  
Stop  
Stop  
Area(s)  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ _ _ : _ _  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
_ _ : _ _ Yes No  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Table 36: Opening/Closing Windows  
The column below briefly describes how to  
activate an Opening/Closing Window.  
eXcept  
Use the guidelines shown in the other  
On  
Holiday  
Index  
Day of Week  
columns to choose the appropriate entries. Holiday  
Areas  
Program at least  
one day Yes.  
Program at least  
one day Yes.  
Program at least  
one day Yes.  
All days must be  
programmed No.  
Day(s) of the week  
NO  
YES  
NO  
NO  
None  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
Select at least Program at least  
one Index one area Yes.  
Select at least Program at least  
one Index one area Yes.  
Select at least Program at least  
Day(s) of the week, but not on holidays  
Day(s) of the Week, plus holidays  
Only on holidays  
one Index  
one area Yes.  
Table 37: Normal Store Hours*  
Open  
Close  
Start  
23 : 00 23: 59  
00 : 00 01 : 00  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
20: 00  
00: 00  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
1
Day of Week  
S M T W T F S  
S M T W T F S  
Start  
05 : 00  
_ _ : _ _  
Stop  
06: 00  
_ _ : _ _  
Stop  
Area(s)  
04: 00  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
Yes No  
Yes No  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
2
_ _ : _ _  
* Monday to Friday, Opening between 5 AM and 6 AM. Closing between 11 PM and 1 AM.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 102  
Table 38: Delivery Schedule*  
Open  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
Day of Week  
Start  
Stop  
Stop  
Area(s)  
3
S M T W T F S  
02 : 30  
02 : 45  
03 : 00  
03 : 05 03: 15  
03: 30  
Yes No  
Yes No  
Yes  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
00 : 00 01 : 00  
Day(s) of the week, but not on holidays  
Program at least  
one day Yes.  
Select at  
least one  
index  
* Monday and Wednesday, In between 2:45 AM and 3:00 AM. Out between 3:15 AM and 3:30 AM.  
Another alternative for delivery schedules is to automatically bypass specific points using skeds.  
Table 39: Monthly Auditor’s Schedule*  
Open  
Close  
Start  
eXcept  
On  
Holiday  
Early  
Begin  
Early  
Begin  
Holiday  
Index  
W#  
Day of Week  
Start  
Stop  
Stop  
Area(s)  
4
S M T W T F S  
07 : 00  
08 : 00  
08 : 30  
14 : 00 14: 30  
17: 00  
Yes No  
1
2
3
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
All days must be  
programmed No.  
Only on holidays  
No  
Select at  
least one  
index  
Program at least  
one area Yes.  
* Sunday, In between 8:00 AM and 8:30 AM. Out between 2:30 PM and 5:00 PM..  
5.1.2 User Group Windows  
User Windows #  
Default:  
Selection: 1 to 8  
In this section, you can create up to eight User  
Group periods where the passcodes for the group  
chosen is enabled. One user group can have  
multiple windows assigned to it over a 24-hour  
period. See the U### User Group prompt in  
Section 3.1 Passcode/Token Worksheet to assign  
individuals to a group.  
1
Enter the User Windows number you want to  
program.  
UW# User Group  
When you assign a U### User Group to one of the  
eight windows, all passcodes for the group are  
enabled ONLY for the period between the Enable  
Time and Disable Time for assigned User Windows  
#.  
Default:  
1
Selection: Blank, 1 to 8  
Enter the number programmed for the group of  
users in the U### User Group prompt. This group  
has its user passcodes enabled/disabled when this  
window runs.  
If a user is not assigned to a U### User Group or  
the number programmed for the user for U###  
User Group is not assigned to a User Windows #,  
the passcode for that user is enabled all the time.  
0101  
A User Group can be assigned to more  
01  
than one window in a 24-hour period, but  
the windows must not overlap or exceed  
the midnight boundary.  
0101  
0101  
User Group Windows DO NOT affect the  
01  
users token/card access authority. To  
enable/disable tokens, the Sked Function  
Access Levels On/Off must be used.  
0101  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 103  
UW# Sunday  
UW# Saturday  
Default: No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Selection: Yes or No  
This prompt, and the next six day of the week  
prompts, select the days of the week that the User  
Group Window is active.  
UW# Group Enable  
Default:  
00:00  
0101  
See the W# Sunday prompt in Section  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
01  
5.1.1 Opening and Closing instructions  
for more information about programming  
this prompt.  
0101  
This prompt must be programmed if this  
User Group Window is assigned to a user  
group.  
UW# Monday  
Enter the time of day that the window starts.  
Beginning at this time, users assigned to this  
window’s group can use their passcodes. The  
window goes into effect at the beginning of the  
minute. Make entries using a 24-hour clock (for  
example, 7:00 AM is entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is  
entered as 14:45).  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
UW# Tuesday  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Disable/Restart the control panel to activate today’s  
window. If you are programming a window that  
needs to activate on the same day that you are  
programming it, do a disable/restart after  
programming.  
UW# Wednesday  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
UW# Group Disable  
UW# Thursday  
Default:  
00:00  
Default:  
No  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Selection: Yes or No  
UW# Friday  
This prompt must be programmed if this  
User Group Window is assigned to a user  
group  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enter the time of day that the window ends. This  
time marks the end of the period in which users  
assigned to this window’s group can use their  
passcodes. The window stops at the end of the  
minute. Make entries using a 24-hour clock (for  
example, 7:00 AM is entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is  
entered as 14:45).  
To disable the window, both the hours and minutes  
spaces must be blank.  
Do not program a single window to cross the  
midnight boundary. The window stop time must be  
later than the window start time.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 104  
Each sked number can be programmed with one of  
24 functions for the S## Function Code. A function  
is executed. In addition to the function, a choice  
must be made as to what is affected by the function  
(for example, when choosing a Disarm Sked, the  
disarming is the function while the areas that are  
being chosen to become disarmed are what is  
affected).  
Holiday Indexes for User Group Windows  
You can enable up to four Holiday Indexes to use  
with User Group Windows. Enable at least one  
Holiday Index if UW# Xept Holiday is  
programmed Yes for this user window, or if you  
want this window to activate only on specific dates.  
Holidays are programmed in Section 5.3 Holiday  
Indexes of the program.  
The functions and their associated parameters are  
listed in the Sked Function Code Table in the  
Program Record Sheet, and they are explained in detail  
following the S## Function Code prompt in this  
section.  
UW# Xept Holiday  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Determine if the window is disabled on holidays, or  
is active only on holidays. Use the instructions  
provided in the W# Xept Holiday prompt in Section  
5.1.1 Opening and Closing.  
Each sked can be programmed with up to four  
Holiday Indexes. The Holiday Indexes can be used  
to execute the sked on the holidays in addition to  
the date or day(s) of the week, or, they can be used  
to prevent the sked from executing on the holidays  
(see S## Xept Holiday prompt in this section ).  
UW# Holiday 1  
Default:  
No  
Sked Number  
Selection: Yes or No  
Default:  
1
UW# Holiday 2  
Selection: 1 to 40  
Enter the number of the sked you are programming.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
S## TimeEdit  
UW# Holiday 3  
Default:  
Yes  
Selection: Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Yes  
No  
The user can edit the time of this sked  
from the command center and it  
appears in the CHG SKED display.  
Selection: Yes or No  
UW# Holiday 4  
The user cannot edit the time of this  
sked from the command center and it  
does NOT appear in the CHG SKED  
display.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
5.2  
Skeds  
Select whether the user can edit the time of this sked  
from the command center.  
Use the Skeds module to program the control panel  
to automatically execute functions that are otherwise  
initiated by the end user at the command center.  
Each sked can be programmed to occur at a specific  
time on a specific date or day of the week. Up to 40  
Skeds can be programmed.  
A sked can be edited from the command center if  
S## Time Edit? is Yes. The date and time can be  
changed using the Change Sked? function.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 105  
S## Function Code  
Enter the function code you want this sked to execute. Sked Function 12 is reserved and is not a valid entry.  
The programmer automatically displays the available parameter choices and range fields for this function (such as,  
Yes/No is automatically displayed for the areas when choosing the Arm/Disarm function while a blank prompt  
exists for the point number you want to bypass when choosing the Bypass Point function).  
After you program the parameter choices associated with the Sked function, press [EXIT GROUP] to continue  
programming the sked for date, day of week, time, and holiday.  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
1 to 11, 13 to 24, 28, 29  
Arm Area: This function simulates the  
Master Arm Delay command center  
function. Entries in the S## Area #  
prompts define the area(s) this sked  
arms. The sked can arm multiple areas.  
If any point is faulted when the sked  
executes, it is force armed regardless of  
FA/Bypass max.  
1
Yes  
No  
Arm Area #.  
S## Area 1[through 8]  
Default: No  
Do not arm Area  
#.  
Selections: Yes or No  
Enable the sked to arm the  
areas indicated with Yes.  
Disarm Area: This function emulates  
the Disarm_ _ _ command center  
function. Entries in the S## Area #  
prompts define the area(s) this sked  
disarms. The sked can disarm multiple  
areas.  
2
3
Yes  
No  
Disarm Area #.  
S## Area 1[through 8]  
Default: No  
Do not disarm  
Area #.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable the sked to disarm the  
areas indicated with Yes.  
Bypass a Point: This function emulates  
the Bypass Pt? command center  
Blank (0)  
No point is to be  
bypassed  
S## Point Number  
function. The entry in the S## Point  
Number prompt defines the point this  
sked bypasses. The point can be  
Default: Blank  
1 to 127,  
129 to 247  
Point to bypass  
Selections: Blank, 1 to 127,  
129 to 247 for D9412G,  
1 to 75 for D7412G  
bypassed only if Bypassable is  
programmed Yes in the point index  
assigned to the point. The bypass is  
reported if Bypass Reports are enabled  
in the point index assigned to the point.  
The sked can bypass one point.  
Enter the number of the point  
the sked bypasses.  
Unbypass a Point: This function  
emulates the Unbypass Pt? command  
center function. The entry in the S##  
Point Number prompt defines the  
point this sked unbypasses. The sked  
can unbypass one point.  
4
Blank (0)  
No point is to be  
unbypassed.  
S## Point Number  
Default: Blank  
1 to 127,  
129 to 247  
Point to unbypass.  
Selections: Blank, 1 to 127,  
129 to 247 for D9412G,  
1 to 75 for D7412G  
Enter the number of the point  
the sked unbypasses.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 106  
Unbypass All Points: This function is  
not available as a command center  
function. The entry in the S## Area #  
prompt defines the area(s) where the  
sked unbypasses all points. The sked  
unbypasses all points in the area,  
regardless of how they were bypassed.  
This sked can unbypass all points in  
multiple areas.  
Yes  
No  
5
Unbypass all  
points in Area #.  
S## Area 1[through 8]  
Default: No  
Do not unbypass  
all points in Area  
#.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable the sked to unbypass all  
points the areas indicated with  
Yes.  
Relay On: This function emulates the  
Chg Relay? command center function  
to turn relays on. The entry in the S##  
Relay Number prompt defines the  
specific relay this sked activates. The  
sked can activate one relay.  
6
7
8
Blank  
No relay is  
activated.  
S## Relay Number  
Default: Blank  
1 to 128  
Relay to activate.  
Selections: Blank,  
1 to 128 for D9412G,  
1 to 64 for D7412G  
Enter the number of the relay  
the sked activates  
Relay Off: This function emulates the  
Chg Relay? command center function  
to turn relays off. The entry in the S##  
Relay Number prompt defines the  
relay this sked turns off. The sked can  
turn off only relays that were set by a  
sked. The sked can turn off one relay.  
Blank  
No relay is turned  
off.  
S## Relay Number  
Default: Blank  
1 to 128  
Relay to turn off.  
Selections: Blank,  
1 to 128 for D9412G,  
1 to 64 for D7412G  
Enter the number of the relay  
that turns the sked off.  
All Relays Off: This function is not available as a command center function. This sked function turns off all  
relays that were turned on by a sked. This is a panel-wide function.  
There are no other parameters that require input for this option.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 107  
Test Report: This function emulates  
the Send Report? command center  
function. This function generates a Test  
Report ONLY from Area 1 but contains  
panel-wide status information. The  
report is sent to the phone(s)  
9
Yes  
No  
Defer the Test  
Report.  
S## Defer Test  
Default: No  
Send the Test  
Report on  
schedule.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable sked to defer the Test  
Report  
programmed for Test and Status  
Reports in Section 2.3.8 Dialing Attempts.  
Yes  
No  
Send the Test  
Report every hour.  
S## Hourly Report  
If Expand Test Prt in Phone is  
programmed Yes, the Test Report also  
includes all off-normal states for events  
listed in Diagnostic Reports and Test  
Reports (see Section 2.3.8 Dialing  
Attempts).  
Default: No  
Send the Test  
Report only as  
scheduled.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable sked to send the Test  
Report every hour.  
The Test Report can be deferred if any  
other report was sent since the last Test  
Report. To defer the Test Report,  
program S## Defer Test.  
The Test Report can be sent every hour  
beginning at the time scheduled in S##  
Time. To send a Test Report every  
hour, program S## Hourly Rpt.  
Status Report: This function generates  
a Status Report for each area that is  
enabled. The report is sent to the  
phone(s) programmed for Test and  
Status Reports in Routing.  
10  
Yes  
No  
Defer the Status  
Report.  
S## Defer Status  
Default: No  
Send the Status  
Report on  
schedule.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Enable sked to defer the Status  
Report.  
The Status Report can be deferred if  
any other report was sent since the last  
Status Report. To defer the Status  
Report, program S## Defer Status.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
11 Execute Custom Func: This function  
EN | 108  
Blank (0) No command center  
is specified for  
S## Cmd Center  
emulates any of the custom functions  
assigned to the command center that  
can be executed by a user from the  
command center. When a sked executes  
a custom function, it is subject to the  
scope of the selected command center.  
Cmd Center and Custom Func  
Custom Function  
activation.  
Default: Blank (0)  
Selections: Blank (0), 1 to 8  
Identify the specific keypad  
(CC #) where the Custom  
Function is entered. Only one  
command center can be  
1 to 8  
Command center  
address specified for  
Custom Function  
activation.  
prompts appear after entering Function  
Code 11. Both entries are required.  
assigned for this sked function.  
Blank (0) No Custom  
Function is  
S## Custom Func  
activated.  
Default: Blank (0)  
Selections: Blank (0),  
128 to 143 for D9412G,  
128 to 131 for D7412G  
128 to  
143  
Custom Function to  
activate.  
Enter the custom function this  
sked executes.  
Avoid having multiple functions occur at the same time at the same address. Functions can clash and the  
effect on the control panel is unpredictable.  
0101  
0101  
001  
Review to make sure that the Custom Function being executed or any of the commands nested inside the  
Custom Function are not passcode protected.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Do not program multiple skeds to execute at the same command center during the same time of execution.  
Do not program skeds to execute at times when a user is likely to be executing functions at the command  
center. If it is necessary to do so, there are two ways to work around the situation:  
1. Program CC at the beginning of the Custom Function Key Strokes entry. This aborts the user’s  
function and allow the sked to execute.  
2. Program the sked to execute at an address (Cmd Center) with no command center physically  
attached to it. The CC # must be assigned to an area and have the appropriate scope programmed.  
13 Adjust Time Forward One Hour: This sked function is used to make adjustments to the control panel’s  
clock. A typical application is to program this to go into effect at 2:00 AM on the date that Daylight Savings  
Time begins (during the springtime). No Time Change Report is sent or logged, but the new time appears in  
the next report logged.  
There are no other parameters that require input for this option.  
14 Adjust Time Backward One Hour: This sked function is used to make adjustments to the control panel’s  
clock. A typical application is to program this to go into effect at 2:00 AM on the date that Daylight Savings  
Time ends (during the fall). This function can operate only once in a day, even if multiple Skeds with this  
function are programmed. No Time Change Report is sent or logged, but the new time appears in the next  
report logged.  
There are no other parameters that require input for this option.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 109  
Sound Watch Tone at  
15  
Yes  
No  
Watch tone sounds  
at this command  
center.  
S## Cmd Center 1[through 8]  
Command Center: This function  
sounds the Watch Tone at the  
command center address  
programmed in Parameter 1. The  
Watch Tone sounds at all  
command centers with the address  
programmed. Press [ESC] to  
silence the tone.  
Default: Blank  
Selection: Yes or No  
Watch tone does not  
sound at this  
command center.  
Enable the sked to beep the command  
center programmed Yes.  
Sound Watch Tone defines the  
command center address where  
the Watch Tone sounds. Enter the  
specific address at the S## Cmd  
Center prompt.  
Access Control Level On: This  
function emulates the ACCESS  
CMD LEVEL command that  
determines whether a user’s  
token/card level is ENABLED?,  
allowing access granted rights.  
This affects all doors that this user  
is assigned to with this specific  
authority level.  
16  
Yes  
No  
Enable Access  
Control Level #  
S## Access Ctl Level #  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable  
Access Control  
Level #.  
Activate a sked, which enables the  
Access Level(s) 1 through 14 with Yes.  
The D9412G supports eight doors; the D7412G supports two doors.  
0101  
01  
0101  
To regulate a user’s access for certain doors, assign the user a different authority level # with the same  
authority functions enabled. For example, a user can be assigned Authority Level 1 for Door 1 and  
Authority Level 2 for the remaining doors. You can enable/disable Authority Level 1 for Door 1 without  
affecting his authority level for Doors 2 through 8).  
Access Control Level Off: This  
function emulates the ACCESS  
CMD LEVEL command that  
determines whether a user’s  
token/card level is disabled. This  
function allows access to be turned  
off for the levels programmed.  
17  
18  
Yes  
No  
Turn off access for  
level #.  
S## Access Ctl Level#  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not turn off  
access for level #.  
The first parameter enables the sked to  
turn off access for levels 1 through 14.  
Unlock Door: This function  
emulates the UNLOCK?  
12345678command center  
function for unlocking a door.  
Yes  
No  
Unlock Door #.  
S## Door 1 [through 8]  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not unlock Door  
#.  
Enable the sked to unlock the doors  
programmed Yes.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 110  
Secure Door: This function  
emulates the SECURE? 12345678  
command center function for  
securing a door.  
19  
Yes  
No  
Secure Door #.  
S## Door 1 [through 8]  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not secure Door  
#.  
Enable the sked to return the doors  
programmed Yes to the secured state.  
Lock Door: This function returns  
an Unlocked (Function 18) or  
Secured (Function 19) door to a  
normal locked door state.  
20  
21  
Yes  
No  
Lock Door #.  
S## Door 1 [through 8]  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not lock Door #.  
Enable the sked to lock the doors  
programmed Yes and return them to  
the normal Door Mode.  
Access Authority Events On:  
The control panel can log Access  
Granted Events when a valid  
token, RTE, REX, or Unlock Door  
Event is detected for a specific  
door. These events can be directed  
to print at a local printer or report  
remotely through phone routing.  
This sked enables Access Granted  
Events to be reported for Door #.  
Yes  
No  
Enable the reporting  
of Access Granted  
Events for Door #.  
S## Door 1 [through 8]  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable the  
reporting of Access  
Granted Events for  
Door #.  
This parameter enables the reporting  
of Access Granted Events for Door #.  
Access Authority Events Off:  
The control panel can log Access  
Granted Events when a valid  
token, RTE, REX, or Unlock Door  
Event is detected for a specific  
door. These events can be directed  
to print at a local printer or report  
remotely through phone routing.  
This sked disables Access Granted  
Events to be reported for Door #.  
22  
Yes  
No  
Disable the  
S## Door 1 [through 8]  
reporting of Access  
Granted Events for  
Door #.  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
This parameter disables the reporting  
of Access Granted Events for Door #.  
Do not disable the  
reporting of Access  
Granted Events for  
Door #.  
No Entry Events On: The control  
panel can log No Entry Events  
when an invalid token is detected  
for a specific door. No Entry  
Events include No Entry-Secured,  
No Entry-Interlock, No Entry-  
Unknown ID, and No Entry-Level.  
These events can be directed to  
print at a local printer or report  
remotely through phone routing.  
This sked enables No Entry Events  
to be reported for Door #.  
23  
Yes  
No  
Enable the reporting  
of No Entry Events  
for Door #.  
S## Door 1 [through 8]  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable the  
reporting of No  
Entry Events for  
Door #.  
This parameter enables the reporting  
of No Entry Events for Door #.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 111  
No Entry Events Off: The control  
panel can log No Entry Events  
when an invalid token is detected  
for a specific door. No Entry  
Events include No Entry-Secured,  
No Entry-Interlock, No Entry-  
Unknown ID, and No Entry-Level.  
These events can be directed to  
print at a local printer or report  
remotely through phone routing.  
This sked disables No Entry  
24  
Yes  
No  
Enable the reporting  
of No Entry Events  
for Door #.  
S## Door 1 [through 8]  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Do not enable the  
reporting of No  
Entry Events for  
Door #.  
This parameter disables the reporting  
of No Entry Events for Door #.  
Events to be reported for Door #.  
Sked Functions 28 and 29 are available only in firmware versions 6.30 and higher. RPS version 3.5 and  
RADXSKED handler version 1.02 and higher must be used to program these new skeds.  
28 Expanded Off-Normal Test Report: To generate this event, one or more points must be in an off-normal  
state at the time the sked executes. In addition, any system trouble that is active also generates an Expanded  
Off-Normal Test Report. Expanded Off-Normal Test Reports include the Off Normal Test Report Event as  
well as the supplementary event at the time the report is generated.  
The Event Log only shows a Test Report Event.  
If none of these conditions exist at the time the sked executes, only a Sked Executed Event is generated and  
the Off-Normal Test Report is not sent.  
To meet UL 864 daily Test Report requirements (when using two phone lines) you must still use Sked  
Function Code 9, Test Report and program it to occur on a daily basis as per AHJ requirements.  
29 Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report: Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report Events are only sent  
when any point is in the off-normal state from any area, but only sends the Off Normal Test Report Event. In  
addition to this, any system trouble that is active also generates a Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report.  
The Event Log only shows a Test Report Event.  
If none of these conditions exist at the time the sked executes, only a Sked Executed Event is generated and  
the Non-Expanded Off-Normal Test Report is not sent.  
To meet UL 864 daily Test Report requirements (when using two phone lines), you must still use Sked  
Function Code 9, Test Report and program it to occur on a daily basis as per AHJ requirements.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 112  
Exceptions:  
S## Time  
To prevent the sked from activating on certain days  
of the year, program Xept Holiday Yes, and enable  
at least one Holiday Index. When Xept Holiday is  
programmed Yes, the window executes on the days  
of the week programmed unless the date is  
designated as a holiday by the Holiday Index  
selected.  
Default:  
00:00  
Selection: HH:MM (hours and minutes)  
Enter the time that the sked executes. Make entries  
using a 24-hour clock (for example, 7:00 AM is  
entered as 07:00, 2:45 PM is entered as 14:45).  
Disabled skeds have a blank time. If you copy the  
control panel and the entry for this prompt is blank,  
but times were at one time programmed, the sked  
may be disabled from the command center using the  
Change Skeds function.  
If a sked is only needed on certain days of the year,  
do not program the sked to execute on any days of  
the week. Instead, program Xept Holiday No, and  
select a Holiday Index with the dates you want the  
window to be active.  
To program a time:  
S## Monday  
4. Press the two digits representing the hour.  
5. The cursor advances past the colon (:) in the  
display.  
6. Press the two digits representing the minutes.  
7. Press [ENTER].  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
S## Tuesday  
Default:  
No  
S## Date  
Selection: Yes or No  
Default:  
_ _ / _ _  
Selection: MM/DD (month and date)  
S## Wednesday  
Enter the date that the sked executes.  
Default:  
No  
Disabled skeds have a blank date. If you copy the  
control panel and the entry for this prompt is blank,  
but dates were programmed before, the sked may be  
disabled from the command center using the  
Change Skeds function.  
Selection: Yes or No  
S## Thursday  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
To program a date:  
8. Press the two digits representing the hour.  
9. The cursor advances past the colon (:) in the  
display.  
10. Press the two digits representing the minutes.  
11. Press [ENTER].  
S## Friday  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
S## Saturday  
S## Sunday  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Activate this sked on Sundays.  
Do not activate this sked on Sundays.  
This prompt and the next six prompts select the  
days of the week that the sked is active.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 113  
5.3  
Holiday Indexes  
S## Xept Holiday  
This programming module has two sections:  
Add/Change/Delete and View Holidays. Use the  
Add/Change/Delete section to program the Holiday  
Indexes. The View Holidays section is a view-only  
section provided for your convenience. Use View  
Holidays to review the dates programmed in the  
Holiday Indexes.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
Prevent this sked from operating on  
the holidays identified in the specific  
Holiday Index(es) used with this sked.  
Specific Holiday Indexes are selected  
in this programming section and  
programmed in the next programming  
module.  
5.3.1 Add/Change/Delete  
Program the dates for each of the Holiday Indexes.  
You can program up to four Holiday Indexes in the  
control panel. Within each index, you can select up  
to 365 dates to be designated as holidays.  
No  
This sked operates on holidays  
programmed in the Holiday Index(es)  
used with this sked.  
The Holiday Indexes function independently of each  
other. The same day can be programmed in all four  
schedules. Holiday Indexes are used in  
programming O/C Windows, User Access  
Windows, and skeds.  
If no days of the week are programmed, this sked  
operates only on the holidays programmed in the  
Holiday Index(es) used with this sked. This sked also  
operates if the holiday falls on a day of the week that  
is programmed.  
Date  
S## Holiday 1  
Default:  
_ _ / _ _  
Default:  
No  
Selection: MM/DD (month and date)  
Selection: Yes or No  
This entry selects the month and day you are  
designating as a holiday.  
Yes  
No  
Use Holiday Index 1 with this sked.  
Do not use Holiday Index 1 with this  
sked.  
To program a date:  
12. Press the two digits representing the month.  
The cursor advances past the slash (/) in the  
display.  
13. Press the two digits representing the day of the  
month.  
S## Holiday 2  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
14. Press [ENTER].  
S## Holiday 3  
To delete a date:  
1. At the Date prompt, enter the month and day  
you want to delete and press [ENTER].  
2. Advance to the holiday index number that you  
want to delete the date from. Change the entry  
to No. Press [ENTER].  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
S## Holiday 4  
If you want the date completely removed as a  
Holiday, it must be programmed No for all of  
the Holiday Index # entries.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 5.0 RADXSKED  
EN | 114  
Holiday Index 1  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Use this date in Holiday Index 1.  
Do not use this date in Holiday Index  
1.  
Holiday Index 2  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Holiday Index 3  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Holiday Index 4  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
5.3.2 View Holidays  
The View Holidays section is a view only section  
provided for your convenience. Use View Holidays  
to review the dates you programmed into each of  
the Holiday Indexes.  
You can view the first 100 dates programmed in  
each of the indexes.  
Index 1 Days  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Enter group or press [] key  
Press [ENTER GROUP] to view the dates  
programmed in Holiday Index 1.  
Press [] key to advance to the next Holiday Index.  
Index 2 Days  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection:  
Enter group or press [] key  
Index 3 Days  
Default:  
Blank  
Enter group or press [] key  
Selection:  
Index 4 Days  
Default:  
Blank  
Enter group or press [] key  
Selection:  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 115  
6.3  
SDI Automation  
6.0 RADXAUX1  
Define the characteristics of the D9133 Serial  
Interface Module when used with Home or Business  
Automation software. The D9133 Serial Interface  
Module is a bi-directional SDI to RS-232 Interface  
Module that allows the control panels to  
send/receive information to/from an external  
software program. This Automation protocol allows  
external software programs to interact and perform  
functions such as: arming and disarming areas,  
changing user passcodes and names, and turning  
relays on and off. The following items allow some  
simple configuration options; however, to receive  
the D9133 Automation protocol you must contact  
Bosch Security Systems Technical Support at 888-  
886-6189.  
6.1  
Introduction  
The RADXAUX1 Handler is primarily used for  
programming Enhanced Communication capabilities  
for the 9000 Series Control Panels. As new features  
(that require new programmable prompts) are  
added, they will most likely be added to a new  
revision of this handler.  
“Enhanced communications” represents the ability  
to provide new communication functions for the  
control panels using the SDI bus including:  
Routing control panel events to a D9133TTL-x  
module.  
Communicating with RPS using a D9133TTL-x  
module.  
Enable SDI Auto  
Communicating with a remote or local head-end  
software package.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
6.2  
RPS and D5200 Handler  
Requirements  
Yes  
No  
Enable Automation software.  
Disable Automation software.  
In order to program the RADXAUX1 parameters  
for the control panels, you must use RPS version 2.8  
or higher and a handler called RADXAUX1. To  
add the RADXAUX1 Handler to your D5200  
Programmer, call the Bosch Security Systems  
Handler Update System at (800) 657-4584.  
Turning this item to Yes enables the automation  
address (SDI Address 80).  
Baud Rate  
Default:  
9600  
This handler currently has six sections: SDI  
Automation, SDI RAM Parameters, Enhanced  
Communications, SDI RAM/Enhanced  
Communication Configuration, Miscellaneous, and  
Cross Point Parameters. The D5200 Handler  
required for these options is found in the  
RADXAUX1 Handler version 1.0 and is available  
on the Handler Update System at Bosch Security  
Systems.  
Selection: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14.4 K  
This item determines the baud rate between the  
D9133 and the external hardware connected to it.  
Since the SDI bus communicates at 9600 baud,  
Bosch Security Systems recommends that this  
prompt also be kept at 9600 baud. Pressing the  
[SPACE] bar on the D5200 toggles through the  
available options.  
Parity/Stop  
Default:  
No/1  
Selection: No/1, No/2, Odd/1, Even/1  
No/1  
No parity, 1 stop bit  
No parity, 2 stop bits  
Odd parity, 1 stop bit  
Even parity, 1 stop bit  
No/2  
Odd/1  
Even/1  
This prompt addresses two items: Parity and the  
number of stop bits. Pressing the [SPACE] bar on  
the D5200 toggles through the available options.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 116  
9133 Supervision  
Status Rate  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
0
Selection: Yes or No  
Selection: 0 to 255  
Yes  
No  
Supervise the D9133 Serial Interface  
Module.  
0
Status information is only sent when  
requested.  
Do not supervise the D9133 Serial  
Interface Module.  
1 to 255  
Status information is sent at the  
interval programmed.  
This item determines whether the D9133 Serial  
Interface Module is supervised or not. If the D9133  
is supervised, disconnecting the D9133 from the  
control panel creates a Trouble SDI 80 Event and  
the command center annunciates a trouble tone (if  
programmed) and display SERVC SDI 80.  
If the Status Rate is set to a value under  
10 and there are 1 to 6 SDI devices  
connected to the system, the fastest the  
control panel can send the status  
information is approximately 1 second. If  
there are more than six SDI devices  
connected to the control panel, the fastest  
the control panel can send the information  
is approximately 1.5 seconds to 2  
seconds.  
Trouble SDI 80 Reports are always  
reported using Area 1’s account number.  
RTS Control  
This item determines how often the default status  
information is sent to the D9133 Serial Interface  
Module. The status information includes:  
Default:  
On  
Selection: On, AutoX, Off, AutoR  
The current point status (normal or off-normal),  
On  
Sets RTS to on (hardware control).  
The control panel’s area status (Master Armed,  
Master Instant Armed, Perimeter Delay Armed,  
Perimeter Instant Armed, Disarmed, Area Entry  
Delay, Perimeter Entry Delay, Area Exit Delay,  
and Perimeter Exit Delay)  
AutoX  
Automatically enables Xon/Xoff  
(software control).  
Off  
Sets RTS off (hardware control).  
Sets this to Auto RTS.  
AutoR  
The control panel status (AC Fail, Battery  
Missing, AC Restore, Battery Low, and so on)  
This item determines how the Request To Send  
Control parameters are defined for the D9133.  
Pressing the [SPACE] bar on the D5200 toggles  
through the available options.  
Relay status (relay on or relay off)  
Entries are in 100 millisecond increments. If a 5 is  
entered, the status information is sent every 500  
milliseconds (or 0.5 seconds). An entry of 10 equals  
1 second.  
DTR Control  
Default:  
On  
6.4  
SDI RAM Parameters  
Selection: On, AutoD, Off  
Configure RAM parameters when communicating  
over a private Local Area or Wide Area Network  
(LAN/WAN). To allow RPS to communicate with a  
control panel over a LAN or WAN, a D9133TTL-E  
SDI-Ethernet Bi-directional Network Interface  
Module and RPS (version 2.8 or higher) is required.  
The computer that RPS is installed on also needs a  
network card. See your information systems’  
administrator for network requirements.  
On  
Sets DTR to on (hardware control).  
AutoD  
Off  
Sets this to Auto DTR.  
Sets DTR off (hardware control).  
This item determines how the Data Terminal Ready  
Control parameters are defined for the D9133.  
Pressing the [SPACE] bar on the D5200 toggles  
through the available options.  
This section allows you to:  
Define the RAM parameters necessary to  
communicate by an external modem that can be  
connected to a D9133DC Direct Connect  
Programming Module.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 117  
Provide for local programming by a D9133  
Serial Interface Module.  
6.4.1 User Interface Modifications for  
COMMAND 43  
Although not listed in this section, RPS still checks  
for the RAM Passcode (see Section 2.7 RAM  
Parameters), Datalock Code, and the control panel  
type to determine if this RAM session should  
continue.  
COMMAND 43 was modified to compensate for the  
ability to communicate with RPS by a network path.  
COMMAND 43’s structure is shown in Figure 5.  
Figure 5: COMMAND 43 Flow Chart  
1
4
3
6
2
11  
11  
9
9
10  
7
11  
10  
8
5
1 - COMMAND 43  
2 - Contact RAM?  
3 - RAM via Phone?  
4 - Seizes phone line and calls RPS  
5 - Answer now?  
7 - Begins RPS session over the network  
8 - Seizes phone line and begins RPS session  
9 - [PREV]  
10 - [NEXT]  
11 - [ENT]  
6 - RAM by network?  
Pressing the [ESC] key while CONTACT RAM?,  
ANSWER NOW?, RAM VIA PHONE?, or RAM VIA  
NETWORK?is displaying exits the user to Idle Text.  
Enable SDI RAM  
Default:  
Yes  
The RAM via Phone? prompt shown in  
Figure 5, if selected, contacts RAM by the  
control panel phone line and not the  
external modem. Users cannot initiate a  
RAM session by the external modem. If you  
are using an external modem, RAM  
sessions can only be initiated by  
programming Answer Armed and Answer  
Disarmed (to a value greater than 0) or  
setting RAM Line Monitor to Yes in  
Section 6.4 SDI RAM Parameters.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Enable RAM sessions over the SDI  
bus.  
Do not enable RAM sessions over the  
SDI bus.  
This item determines if the control panel allows RPS  
communications over the SDI bus. This item must  
be set to Yes if you plan on using the external  
modem configuration, a private LAN or WAN, or  
local RPS programming.  
If the reset pin is in the locked position,  
local RPS programming is allowed even if  
this prompt is set to No.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 118  
This prompt and the next three prompts determine  
the IP address for RPS.  
When configuring this item to allow for  
local programming, the D9133 needs  
Jumper 8 shorted, power must be cycled  
after changing the address, and a standard  
serial modem cable is required.  
An IP address consists of four fields. Each field has a  
range of 0 to 255. For example, an IP address is  
expressed as 110.227.64.190. The D5200  
programmer splits the IP Address into four  
programmable fields. Be sure you contact your  
network administrator to find out the IP address to  
which the RPS computer is connected.  
Call Back Enabled  
Default:  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
When the control panel hears the  
No  
Figure 6: RAM IP Address Prompts  
proper RAM password (see RAM  
Passcode in Section 2.7 RAM  
110.227.64.190  
Parameters), it ends the SDI RAM  
session and then attempts to reconnect  
to RAM using the RAM IP Address if  
Enable Ext Modem is set to No. If  
Enable Ext Modem is set to Yes, the  
control panel attempts to re-establish  
communication with RAM using the  
RAM Dial String. This ensures that the  
control panel only communicates with  
valid RAM units.  
RAM IP Address 1  
RAM IP Address 2  
RAM IP Address 3  
RAM IP Address 4  
Set this item to 0 if Enable Ext Modem is  
set to Yes.  
No  
The SDI RAM session is initiated  
immediately; no call back is required.  
The control panel can engage in SDI  
RAM sessions regardless of originating  
location.  
RAM IP Address 2  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 255  
Using this function allows the control panel, after  
verifying the RAM passcode, to provide an  
additional level of security. Before allowing any  
upload or download, it ends the SDI RAM session  
and then reconnects with RAM using one of the  
following:  
See RAM IP Address 1.  
RAM IP Address 3  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 255  
The RAM IP Address (Enable Ext Modem  
must be set to No)  
See RAM IP Address 1.  
RAM IP Address 4  
The RAM Dial String (Enable Ext Modem  
must be set to Yes)  
Default:  
0
In firmware version 6.30, do not enable  
RAM Call Back when using an external  
modem.  
Selection: 0 to 255  
See RAM IP Address 1.  
6.4.2 Using an External Modem  
RAM IP Address 1  
Default:  
Selection: 0 to 255  
0 to 255 Enter the first three digits of the IP  
Through the use of a standard, off-the-shelf modem  
(capable of communicating at 9600 baud) and a  
D9133DC connected directly to the control panel,  
RPS can now communicate with a 9000 Series  
Control Panel (version 6.3 or higher) at speeds of up  
to 9600 baud.  
0
address. If the field is one or two digits  
in length, leading zeros are not  
required.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 119  
For Best Data Smart One V.92:  
Type [A][T][S][3][7][=][9][Enter]  
For US Robotics:  
Both the U.S.Robotics V.92 56 K Modem  
(model # 5686, includes V.92 and V.90  
56 K standard technology) and the Best  
Data Smart One V.92/V.44 56 K External  
Data/Fax Modem (model # 56SX-92) are  
recommended for use as external modems  
(connected to the control panel) based on  
compatibility testing by Bosch Security  
Systems. Other modules were either not  
tested or found compatible.  
Type [A][T][&][N][6][Enter].  
This sets the baud rate of the modem to 9600. For  
modems other than US Robotics or Best Data Smart  
One V.92, consult your individual modem’s  
instructions for the correct text string.  
Type [A][T][E][0][Enter]. This eliminates echo,  
making all user input from this point forward  
invisible on screen.  
Type [A][T][&][W][0][Enter] to write the  
configuration to modem memory. The modem  
profile is saved to a file upon disconnection or  
power loss.  
The external modem is connected to the D9133DC  
Direct Connect Programming Module, which in  
turn, is connected to the SDI bus using SDI Address  
88 (see Figure 8). A standard serial cable is required  
to connect the D9133DC to the external modem.  
The following seven prompts help configure the  
requirements necessary to connect an external  
modem to a D9412G/D7412G Control Panel using  
a D9133DC. This configuration allows you to  
communicate with RPS at 9600 baud because  
communication is being routed through the SDI bus.  
Use a separate phone line if an external  
modem is being connected to the control  
panel by a D9133DC Direct Connect  
Programming Module. If it is not possible  
to obtain a different phone line than the  
control panel is using, make sure the  
control panel is still wired in front of any  
premises phone and the external modem  
devices so that full line seizure is  
If you are going to use an external modem  
for RPS communications, enhanced  
communications, and RPS functions using  
a D9133TTL-E are disabled.  
maintained. Also, make sure the following  
items are programmed in Section 2.7  
RAM Parameters:  
Answer Armed = Blank or 0  
Answer Disarmed = Blank or 0  
RAM Line Monitor = No  
RAM Call Back = No  
RAM Phone number = Blank  
When using an external modem, it must  
be initialized using the following  
HyperTerminal procedure on your  
computer. The HyperTerminal procedures  
can vary depending upon the operating  
system used.  
3. In Windows®, open the HyperTerminal  
application within  
ProgramsAccessoriesCommunications.  
4. Connect the modem to an available COM port.  
5. Once connected, select the appropriate COM  
port within HyperTerminal. See Figure 7.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 120  
Figure 7: Com Port Selection within HyperTerminal  
Figure 8: External Modem Connection  
4
3
1
2
2
D9133DC  
5
6
1 - RPS Remote Account Manager  
2 - Modem  
3 - PSTN  
4 - D9412G/D7412G Control Panel  
5 - Standard serial cable  
6 - SDI bus  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 121  
In order to use an off-the-shelf external modem and a D9133DC serial module to connect to the control  
panel using RAM, use the following settings:  
1. RADXAUX1\ENHANCED COMM\Enhanced Comm\No  
2. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\Enable SDI RAM\Yes  
3. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\Callback Enabled\No  
4. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\RAM IP Address 1-4\0  
5. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\Enable Ext Modem\Yes  
6. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\Answer Armed\1 to 15  
7. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\Answer Disarmed\1 to 15  
8. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\RAM Line Monitor\No  
9. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\Seize Relay\No  
10. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\Modem Init String\ATE0  
11. RADXAUX1\SDI RAM PARAMETERS\RAM Dial String\ (blank)  
12. RADXAUX1\SDIRAM/ENHANCED CONF\Baud Rate\9600  
13. RADXAUX1\SDIRAM/ENHANCED CONF\Parity/Stop No\1  
14. RADXAUX1\SDIRAM/ENHANCED CONF\RTS Control\ON  
15. RADXAUX1\SDIRAM/ENHANCED CONF\DTR Control\ON  
16. RADXAUX1\SDIRAM/ENHANCED CONF\9133 Supervision\No  
17. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG1 Primary SDI\No  
18. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG1 Backup SDI\No  
19. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG2 Primary SDI\No  
20. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG2 Backup SDI\No  
21. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG3 Primary SDI\No  
22. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG3 Backup SDI\No  
23. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG4 Primary SDI\No  
24. 9000MAIN\PANEL WIDE PARAMETER\Enhanced Routing\RG4 Backup SDI\No  
25. The control panel reset pin can be up or down.  
26. The modem at the control panel location must be set for 9600 baud and echo off. This information  
must be written to the modem configuration area. Hyperterminal can be used to send the following  
Hayes modem commands (see the Modem Manual for command syntax):  
ATS37=9 (set baud rate to 9600)  
ATE0 (eliminate echo)  
AT&W0 (write configuration to modem memory, not echoed)  
27. Ensure the modem at RPS is set up for 9600 baud.  
28. From the control panel communication window on RPS, connect by modem at 9600 baud.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 122  
Enable Ext Modem  
RAM Line Monitor  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Enable SDI Address 88 for use with an  
external modem.  
This item is not yet implemented. Keep this item set  
to No.  
Disable SDI Address 88 for use with an  
external modem.  
Seize Relay  
Default:  
No  
Setting this item to Yes instructs the control panel  
that SDI Address 88 is enabled for use with an  
external modem. For further information on Local  
RPS programming, see the RPS Operation Manual.  
Selection: Yes or No  
This item is not yet implemented. Keep this item set  
to No.  
Setting this item to Yes disables  
Enhanced Communication and SDI RAM  
for use over a LAN or WAN.  
Modem Init String  
Default:  
ATE0  
Selection: A to Z (capital letters only), 0 to 9,  
[SPACE], ! “ # $ % & ‘ ( ) * + , - . / : ;  
< = > ? @ [ \ ] ^ _  
Answer Armed  
Default:  
7
Selection: 0 to 15  
Determines which initialization string the control  
panel sends to the external modem when the control  
panel powers up.  
0
No answer when all areas are Master  
Armed.  
0101  
If special characters are required, this  
0 to 15  
The control panel answers the phone  
after the specified number of rings  
when all areas are Master Armed.  
0101  
item can only be programmed  
successfully from RPS. The D5200  
Programmer only allows the characters  
shown in the Modem Init String  
default/selections.  
001  
Determines the number of rings after which the  
external modem automatically answers a call if all  
areas are Master Armed.  
RAM Dial String  
Answer Disarmed  
Default:  
ATDT  
Default:  
7
Selection: Not available  
This item is not yet implemented.  
Selection: 0 to 15  
0
No answer when any area is Perimeter  
Armed or Disarmed.  
6.5  
Enhanced Communications  
0 to 15  
The control panel answers the phone  
after the specified number of rings  
when any area is Perimeter Armed or  
Disarmed.  
Enhanced communications is the ability to  
communicate by some other means than the  
standard digital dialer. In this section, programmable  
parameters allow you to define up to four separate  
enhanced communication paths to which events can  
be routed. To route an event (such as an Alarm or  
Trouble) to an enhanced communication path,  
additional programming must also be completed in  
Section 2.3 Routing and Section 2.4 Enhanced Routing.  
Determines the number of rings after which the  
external modem automatically answers a call if any  
area is Perimeter Armed or Disarmed.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 123  
This prompt and the next three determine the IP  
addresses for each of the four paths available when  
using the D5200.  
Enhanced Comm  
Default:  
No  
An IP address consists of four fields. Each field has a  
range of 0 to 255. For example, an IP address is  
expressed as 110.227.64.190. The D5200  
programmer splits the IP address into four  
programmable fields (see Figure 9). Be sure you  
contact your network administrator to find out  
exactly where to send IP Address Events.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Enable enhanced communications over  
the SDI bus.  
Do not enable enhanced  
communications over the SDI bus.  
Determines if the control panel allows enhanced  
communications over the SDI bus.  
Figure 9: Path # IP Add1 to Add4  
0101  
Modem Format must be set to Yes when  
using enhanced communications.  
0101  
001  
110.227.64.190  
Enable Ext Modem must be set to No if  
enhanced communications are to be  
used.  
Path # IP Add1  
Path # IP Add2  
Path # IP Add3  
Path # IP Add4  
Enhanced Comm must be set to No if an  
external modem is to be used.  
In order to completely disable Enhanced  
Routing over an SDI path, RG#Primary  
SDI, RG#Backup SDI, and Enhanced  
Comm prompts must all be set to No.  
Path # IP Add2  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 255  
6.5.1 Programming Path Numbers and IP  
Addresses  
See Path 1 IP Add1.  
There are up to four available paths to which events  
can be routed. If an event (or group of events) is to  
be routed to an SDI path, the number entered in  
Primary Device determines which SDI path is used  
(as long as RG# Prim, Primary SDI was set to Yes  
in Routing).  
Path # IP Add3  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 255  
See Path 1 IP Add1.  
If events are to be routed to an IP address (in a  
private LAN/WAN application), determine which  
path is used (Path 1 to Path 4), and enter the  
appropriate IP Address for that path (see Path # IP  
Add1 to Path # IP Add4).  
Path # IP Add4  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 255  
See Path 1 IP Add1.  
If events are to be routed to an SDI Path but not to  
an IP Address, leave the Path # IP Add# set to 0.  
Path # Poll Rate, Path # Ack Wait, and Path #  
Retry Count must still be programmed.  
Path # Poll Rate  
Default:  
Selection: 0, 5 to 65535 seconds  
Disables the heartbeat poll (not  
0
Path # IP Add1  
0
Default:  
Selection: 0 to 255  
0 to 255  
Enter the first three digits of the IP  
0
recommended, see the first Important  
Note that follows).  
5 to 65535 Enables the poll rate for the amount of  
time programmed here.  
address. If the first field is one or two  
digits in length, leading zeros are not  
required.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 124  
This prompt and the next two prompts determine  
how the SDI Path is supervised between the SDI  
device and the central station(s). Do not confuse with  
the supervision of the SDI device (the connection of  
the SDI device to the 9000 series control panel).  
Each SDI Path can be configured to transmit a  
Heartbeat Event to the central station for supervision  
purposes. This ensures the integrity of the  
Each time the SDI Path sends this Heartbeat Event,  
it expects an acknowledgement within the amount of  
time programmed in Path # Ack Wait. If the  
acknowledgement is not received, the control panel  
checks to see if the Path # Retry Count entry is  
greater than 0. If so, the control panel retries the  
number of times programmed (in Path # Retry  
Count) to send the Heartbeat Event before declaring  
the Path as failed and generating a COMM FAIL  
SDI ## (Path 1 = SDI 88, Path 2 = SDI 89, Path 3 =  
SDI 90, Path 4 = SDI 91) Event. If Poll Rate is  
programmed with a value and the central station  
does not acknowledge the poll from the control  
panel, command centers do not annunciate a trouble  
condition. To transmit this event to the central  
station, see the Comm Fail prompt in Section 2.13.2  
Panel-Wide Relays.  
connection at all times.  
When sending reports to a central station  
receiver over a network path, this  
programming prompt must be set to a non-  
zero value. Failure to program a value into  
this field could prevent a failed network  
communications path from restoring back  
to normal.  
Example of Heartbeat:  
If the control panel is programmed to send  
Heartbeat Events to the central station,  
consider the frequency. If the poll rate to  
the central station is less than 60 seconds,  
the connection with RPS over a LAN or  
WAN becomes increasingly difficult the  
lower the poll rate is set.  
Path # Poll Rate is set to 120 seconds  
Path # Ack Wait time is set to 10 seconds  
Path # Retry Count is set to 2  
When the control panel first powers up, the first  
Heartbeat Event for Path 1 is sent and is  
acknowledged in 1 second. 120 seconds after the  
first Heartbeat Event is sent, the second Heartbeat  
Event for Path 1 is generated and sent to the central  
station.  
The control panel readjusts the poll rate if it  
is less than 300 seconds to a temporary  
poll rate of 300 seconds when online with  
RPS. The poll rate returns to the  
programmed value after the RPS session is  
over.  
Example of Retry Count:  
An acknowledgement of the heartbeat was not  
received in 10 seconds. The Heartbeat Event re-  
sends after the first 10 second ack wait period  
expires. If this Heartbeat Event is not acknowledged,  
the control panel declares this path as failed (and  
generates the Comm Fail ## Event). It continues to  
re-send the Heartbeat Event every 10 seconds until  
it is acknowledged.  
Figure 10: Poll Rate Timeline  
4
2
3
5
6
7
1
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 210  
8
9
1 - Control panel powered up  
2 - Acknowledgement received  
3 - Heartbeat Event sent  
6 - No acknowledgement, Heartbeat re-sent, retry #2  
7 - Path declared as failed  
8 - 10-second interval  
4 - Second Heartbeat Event sent  
5 - No acknowledgement, Heartbeat re-sent, retry #1  
9 - Additional Heartbeats sent every 10 seconds until  
acknowledged  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 125  
The value entered for Path # Ack Wait  
Tone must not equal the time out entry  
made in the RPS Account (see the RPS  
Operation Manual, v2.9 or higher). Instead,  
offset these values by 2 or 3. For example,  
if your Path # Ack Wait time = 15,  
program your Time Out value as 17 in the  
RPS account.  
Once the control panel receives acknowledgement  
from the central station, the control panel returns to  
the normal Poll Rate (which, in this example is 120  
seconds).  
If more than one SDI Path is used, the control panel  
handles them on a successive basis. For example, if  
acknowledgement from SDI Path 1 is not received  
within 10 seconds (using the previous example), the  
control panel moves to SDI Path 2 to send its  
Heartbeat Event (and subsequently waits for the ack)  
before returning to SDI Path 1 to re-send its  
heartbeat.  
Path # Retry Count  
Default:  
Selection: 0 to 255  
5
Beginning with firmware revision 6.20, if  
Heartbeats are enabled and primary is an  
SDI (or IP address) and the primary path  
fails due to a heartbeat failure, then all  
events should immediately go to the  
backup path.  
0
COMM FAIL RG# SDI ### Events  
are not generated.  
1 to 255  
COMM FAIL RG# SDI ### Events  
are generated after the number of  
retries are reached for a given SDI  
path.  
Entries are made in 1-second increments.  
Determines how many times the control panel  
resends the Heartbeat Event before declaring a path  
failure and generating a COMM FAIL RG# SDI  
### (RG # = 1 to 4, SDI ### = 88 for Path 1, 89  
for Path 2, 90 for Path 3, 91 for Path 4) Event.  
0101  
Even though RPS and the D5200 allow  
entries of 1 to 4, the control panel  
interprets these entries as an entry of 5.  
01  
0101  
0101  
01  
0101  
5 minutes = 300 seconds  
1 hour = 3600 seconds  
12 hours = 43,200 seconds  
18 hours = 64,800 seconds  
6.6  
SDI RAM/Enhanced  
Communications Configuration  
This section provides the necessary prompts needed  
for configuring the D9133TTL-E SDI-Ethernet  
Interface Module when using it for SDI RAM  
and/or SDI enhanced communication applications.  
Path # Ack Wait  
Default: 13  
Selection: 0, 5 seconds to 65535 seconds  
Baud Rate  
0
The control panel does not look for  
any acknowledgement from the central  
station.  
Default:  
9600  
Selection: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14.4 K  
This item determines the communication baud rate  
for the D9133TTL-E. Because the SDI bus  
communicates at 9600 baud, keep this prompt also  
at 9600 baud. Pressing the [SPACE] bar on the  
D5200 toggles through the available options.  
5 to 65535 The control panel waits this amount of  
time to receive an acknowledgement  
from the central station.  
Determines how long the control panel waits for an  
acknowledgement from the central station after a  
Heartbeat Event (poll) or an actual event was  
transmitted. This prompt is only applicable to SDI  
transmitted events. Entries are made in 1-second  
increments.  
Do not change this value to any other  
setting than 9600 baud.  
0101  
01  
0101  
Even though RPS and the D5200 allow  
entries of 1 to 4, the control panel  
interprets these entries as an entry of 5.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 126  
Parity/Stop  
This item must be set to On when using  
the External Modem feature.  
Default:  
No/1  
Selection: No/1, No/2, Odd/1, Even/1  
9133 Supervision  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
No/1  
No parity, 1 stop bit.  
No parity, 2 stop bits.  
Odd parity, 1 stop bit.  
Even parity, 1 stop bit.  
No/2  
Odd/1  
Even/1  
Yes  
Supervise the D9133TTL-E Network  
Interface Module.  
This prompt addresses two items: Parity and the  
number of stop bits for the D9133TTL-E. Pressing  
the [SPACE] bar on the D5200 toggles through the  
available options.  
No  
Do not supervise the D9133TTL-E  
Network Interface Module.  
This item determines whether the D9133TTL-E is  
supervised or not. If the D9133TTL-E is supervised,  
disconnecting it from the control panel creates a  
Trouble SDI 88 Event and the command  
centerannunciates a trouble tone and displays  
SERVC SDI 88.  
This item must be set to No/1 when using  
the External Modem feature.  
RTS Control  
Default:  
On  
Trouble SDI 88 Reports are always  
reported using Area 1’s account number.  
Selection: On, AutoX, Off, AutoR  
On  
Sets RTS to on (hardware control).  
Base Port Number  
Auto X  
Automatically enables Xon/Xoff  
(software control).  
Default:  
7700  
Off  
Sets RTS off (hardware control).  
Sets this to Auto RTS.  
Selection: 0 to 65535  
Auto R  
The base port number is the port number of the  
CoBox , such as 7700. This is used in the future  
revision and is not needed at this time.  
Determines how the Request To Send Control  
parameters are defined for the D9133TTL-E.  
Pressing the [SPACE] bar on the D5200 toggles  
through the available options.  
6.6.1 Route Group Attempts  
This section determines how many times a route  
group tries the primary destination before  
attempting the backup destination should the  
primary destination fail. This entry applies to both  
Phone numbers and IP addresses.  
This item must be set to On when using  
the External Modem feature.  
DTR Control  
Default:  
On  
Selection: On, AutoD, Off  
On  
Sets DTR to on (hardware control).  
AutoD  
Off  
Sets this to Auto DTR.  
Sets DTR off (hardware control).  
Determines how the Data Terminal Ready Control  
parameters are defined for the D9133TTL-E.  
Pressing the [SPACE] bar on the D5200 toggles  
through the available options.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 127  
RG# 1 Attempt  
Enable Anti Replay  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
This route group attempts the primary  
This feature is used primarily for two purposes:  
destination once and, if unsuccessful,  
attempts the backup destination. The  
control panel still makes a total of ten  
attempts (five to the primary, five to  
the backup) before generating a route  
group Comm Fail Event.  
Anti-Replay: A strategy designed against replay  
attacks. This feature prevents substitution of a  
control panel/network interface module (NIM)  
solution for delivering events over a network.  
A replay attack occurs when a hacker records a  
message sent over the network by Device A and  
replaces this message at a later time while  
pretending to be Device A.  
This route group attempts the primary  
destination twice and, if unsuccessful,  
attempts the backup destination. The  
control panel still makes a total of ten  
attempts (six to the primary, four to the  
backup) before generating a route  
group Comm Fail Event.  
If this function is required, you must also  
enable the Anti-Replay function in the  
D6600 Receiver. See the D6600  
Operation and Installation Manual  
(P/N: 39964) for further details.  
6.7  
Miscellaneous  
Account Identification: With version 6.0, the  
D6600 Receiver identified NetCom accounts by the  
IP address received in the message sent from the  
control panel. With version 6.2, the D6600 Receiver  
can identify the NetCom accounts by either the IP  
address and/or the account number received in the  
message sent from the control panel. The account  
number transmitted in the message is always Area  
1’s account number. Although up to ten digits can  
be programmed for the account number, only eight  
digits are sent in the message to the D6600 receiver.  
Fire Supv Res Type  
Default:  
Selection: 0, 1, 2  
0
0
1
2
The control panel transmits a FIRE  
TROUBLE RESTORE when a Fire  
Supervision point restores to normal.  
The control panel transmits a FIRE  
ALARM RESTORE when a Fire  
Supervision point restores to normal.  
Fire Trouble Resound  
The control panel transmits a FIRE  
SUPERVISION RESTORE when a  
Fire Supervision point restores to  
normal.  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0, 1, 2  
0
1
Command centers do not re-sound the  
fire trouble tone.  
Determines how the control panels transmits a Fire  
Supervision Restoral Event.  
Command centers re-sound the fire  
trouble tone at 12:00 PM if any Fire  
point that falls within the scope of a  
command center is in an off-normal  
condition.  
0101  
Beginning with version 6.20, the Fire Supv  
01  
Restore Event was added to Fire Events in  
Routing. It is not necessary to set this item  
to 2 any longer. If Fire Supervision Restore  
Events are needed, simply enable them in  
Routing.  
0101  
2
Command centers re-sound the fire  
trouble tone at 12:00 AM if any Fire  
point that falls within the scope of a  
command center is in an off-normal  
condition.  
Enable Protocol Type  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Not required at this time. Leave at default value.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 128  
This item determines if a fire trouble condition,  
previously acknowledged and silenced at a  
Table 40: Cross Point Ranges Within Groups  
command center, automatically (locally) resounds  
the fire trouble tone at 12:00 PM, 12:00 AM, or not  
at all if the point is still in an off-normal state. Events  
are not generated at the time resound occurs.  
Cross Point Group Point Range  
1
1
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
to  
8
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
64  
72  
80  
88  
96  
104  
112  
120  
127  
136  
144  
152  
160  
168  
176  
184  
192  
200  
208  
216  
224  
232  
240  
247  
2
9
6.8  
Cross Point Parameters  
3
17  
This section discusses the requirements necessary to  
program Cross Point functions.  
4
25  
5
33  
If a 9000 Series Control Panel is upgraded  
to version 6.30, you MUST use  
6
41  
7
49  
RADXAUX1 Handler version 1.05 or  
higher. Failure to do so may cause  
unexpected point response behavior (see  
Section 6.2 RPS and D5200 Handler  
Requirements.)  
8
57  
9
65  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
73  
81  
89  
97  
The Cross Point option is designed to reduce false  
alarms. To achieve this, points can be programmed  
such that the control panel needs to see an Alarm  
condition within a programmed period of time  
(called Cross Point Time) from at least two points  
within a Cross Point Group (see Table 40) before  
Cross Point Alarm Events are generated. These  
points need the Cross Point option enabled in their  
corresponding point indexes to be able to generate  
this event.  
105  
113  
121  
129  
137  
145  
153  
161  
169  
177  
185  
193  
201  
209  
217  
225  
233  
241  
Cross Point Groups were established in the D9412G  
and D7412G to support the Cross Point functions.  
There are 31 Cross Point Groups in the D9412G  
and ten in the D7412G. Each Cross Point Group  
consists of eight points and is identified by the point  
numbers in them (for example, Cross Points 1 to 8,  
Cross Points 9 to 16, and so on). The maximum  
number of points that can be programmed to meet  
the Cross Point criteria is two. Point numbers from  
different Cross Point Groups do not affect each  
other. See Table 40 for a complete listing of Cross  
Points comprising each Cross Point Group.  
When any Cross Point detects an alarm condition,  
the control panel starts a timer as programmed in  
the Cross Point Time prompt.  
If a second Cross Point within the same Cross Point  
Group detects an alarm condition, the control panel  
creates a Cross Point Alarm Event for both points,  
provided both points activate inside the Cross Point  
Window.  
If a single Cross Point detects an alarm and stays  
faulted throughout the Cross Point Window, a  
standard Alarm Report is generated for that point.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 129  
Conversely, if a single Cross Point detects an alarm,  
then restores, and no other conditions occur, an  
Unverified Event is generated for that point. A  
second alarm on the first point does not create an  
Alarm Event but rather an Unverified Event.  
Section 2.3 Routing determines whether these events  
are transmitted to a central station. An Unverified  
Event does not produce a corresponding Restoral  
Event.  
The Cross Point function applies only to alarm  
conditions. It does not apply to supervisory or  
trouble conditions. Points programmed with point  
response D (Delayed) eventually go into an alarm  
condition if the area is not disarmed in time.  
Use the Cross Point function on Non-fire  
points only.  
Cross Point Time  
Default:  
20 seconds  
Selection: 5 seconds to 255 seconds  
Select the amount of time (in seconds) that points  
within a Cross Point Group are in alarm before a  
Cross Point event is generated.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 6.0 RADXAUX1  
EN | 130  
Notes  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 7.0 RADXAXS  
EN | 131  
D#CC#Scope  
7.0 RADXAXS  
7.1 Door Profile  
Default:  
Blank  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 8  
This programming category is used to:  
1 to 8  
Determines disarming rights. The  
Assign an area, that also activates the D9210B  
Assign a point to the door  
user’s access level in conjunction with  
the CC # Scope determines which  
areas are disarmed.  
Program the door state to change when the arm  
state changes  
Blank  
Only the area assigned to the D#  
Entry Area disarms this door.  
Allow for the Strike relay to activate upon a fire  
alarm  
Enter the command center number (CC#) which  
determines the scope of the user ID’s disarming  
rights. Areas disarm on the basis of this command  
center’s scope and the authority level of the user.  
Door #  
Default:  
20 seconds  
Selection: 1 seconds to 8 seconds  
D# Door Point  
Enter the number of the door you are about to  
program.  
Default:  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 127, 129 to 247  
1 to 127, The point number assigned to this  
129 to 247 door. Points 128 and 248 are reserved  
by the control panel for internal use.  
Blank  
The D9412G supports up to eight doors.  
The D7412G supports two doors.  
Blank  
There is no point number assigned to  
this door.  
D# Entry Area #  
Default:  
Blank  
Enter the point number assigned to this door. This  
point cannot be used for any other point  
assignments.  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 8  
1 to 8  
Blank  
The area assigned to the door  
controller to which the reader allows  
access.  
Door points must be programmed as  
Perimeter points. If a 24-hour point type is  
required for the Door point, you may use a  
Perimeter point type with a point response  
of 9 to C. Also, the debounce count must  
be set to 4 in Point Assignments.  
Door controller does not function.  
Assign an area to the door controller. This entry  
allows the D9210B to be polled, activating  
communication to the control panel. This also is the  
area a user exits when initiating a REX.  
0101  
When assigning Points 1 to 8 (control  
panel zones), the end-of-line (EOL)  
01  
All SDI devices, regardless of area  
0101  
assigned, report to Area 1, Account 1 by  
default upon SDI failure. If a D9210B  
becomes disconnected, an SDI Fail ##  
and a Missing Point ### Event is created.  
resistors must be removed from the control  
panel. In addition to this, do not enable any  
POPIT points (or OctoPOPIT points)  
sharing the same point number as the  
Door point. Failure to do so results in extra  
point trouble conditions upon reboot.  
0101  
9210 NOT READYappears at this  
01  
command center when you press the  
[ENTER] key if the D9210B is not  
programmed with a D# Entry Area.  
0101  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 7.0 RADXAXS  
EN | 132  
D# Interlock Point  
Doors that are activated by Fire Unlock  
must be returned to normal using the Door  
Control function on the control center.  
Default:  
Selection: Blank, 1 to 127, 129 to 247  
1 to 127, The point number assigned to the  
129 to 247 Interlock point. Points 128 and 248 are  
reserved by the control panel for  
internal use.  
Blank  
D# Fire Unlock?  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Blank  
There is no point number assigned to  
the Interlock point.  
Yes  
Relay activates and shunt is applied for  
the door contact automatically upon a  
Fire Alarm.  
Enter the Interlock point number. This point, when  
faulted, prevents the door controller from allowing  
access upon a valid ID read or door request.  
No  
Door remains in its current mode upon  
a Fire Alarm.  
Do not assign this point to another Door point. You  
may assign it to another controller. One Interlock  
point prevents multiple controllers from activating.  
Use this program item to activate the relay for the  
door strike and shunt the door zone automatically  
upon a Fire Alarm. This feature overrides a Secure  
Door state, Locked Door state, Auto Door, and an  
Interlock Faulted point. The relay activates for all  
doors with this prompt programmed Yes when a  
Fire Alarm occurs in any area. Relays that are  
activated by Fire Unlock can only be returned to  
normal through the command center using the Door  
Control function.  
Door points must be programmed as  
Perimeter points. If a 24-hour point type is  
required for the Door point, you can use a  
Perimeter point type with a Point  
Response of 9 to C. Also, the debounce  
count must be set to 4 in Point  
Assignments.  
This unlocks the door regardless of the  
armed state.  
The Interlock point is considered in a  
normal state if it is bypassed, swinger  
bypassed, or forced armed. This results in  
normal access even if the door is left open.  
Each fire alarm that is generated causes a  
Door Unlocked – Automatic Event.  
D# Auto Door?  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
D# Disarm on Open?  
Yes  
When the area assigned in D# Entry  
Default:  
Yes  
Area # is disarmed, the door is in the  
unlocked state. When that area is  
armed, the door returns to the locked  
state.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
The area disarms only after the door  
was opened for a user with a valid  
disarm level.  
No  
Door state is not affected by the armed  
state of the area.  
The area disarms whether or not the  
door was opened as soon as a user with  
a valid disarm level presents a valid  
token/card.  
Use this program item to automatically unlock the  
door (latched, shunt, and strike) when the entry area  
is disarmed. The door re-locks upon Master or  
Perimeter Arming the area.  
Use this program item to determine whether the  
door needs to be physically opened prior to  
disarming the area upon a valid access request. The  
user initiating the access request needs access levels  
that allow disarming with ID.  
The unlocked state cannot be overridden  
manually.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 7.0 RADXAXS  
EN | 133  
D# Buzz Time  
Default: 2 seconds  
Selection: Blank, 1 second to 240 seconds  
D# Card Type  
Default:  
0
Selection: 0 to 3  
Blank  
Buzz Time is not programmed for this  
door.  
0
3
Card format is 26-bit Wiegand.  
Do not use.  
1 to 240  
The buzzer sounds for the amount of  
time programmed.  
This item must be kept to a value of 0 (26 bit  
Wiegand format).  
Enter the amount of time the buzzer output activates  
to notify the user that the strike was activated and  
the door is ready to open. The buzzer stops as soon  
as the door is opened.  
7.2  
Strike Profile  
This programming category is used to create a  
specific door profile for:  
Strike and shunt times.  
A separate buzzer is required. Many  
readers have an internal buzzer that is not  
affected by Buzz Time.  
Extending strike and shunt times if a door is left  
open.  
Resetting the strike when the door opens.  
Programming the Interlock point.  
D# Extend Time  
Default:  
10  
Door #  
Selection: Blank, 1 second to 30 seconds  
Enter the amount of time that strike, buzz, and shunt  
activation is prolonged if a door is left open and the  
shunt time expires. At the end of the programmed  
extend time, the buzzer continues to buzz until the  
door is closed. In addition, if programmed, the point  
assigned to the door indicates a trouble, alarm, or  
fault at the command center.  
Default:  
1
Selection: 1 to 8  
Enter the door you are programming.  
D# Strike Time  
Default:  
10 seconds  
0101  
Selection: 1 second to 240 seconds  
The CLOSE DOOR #display on  
command center does not activate if no  
time (blank) is programmed.  
01  
0101  
Blank  
Strike Time is not programmed for this  
door.  
1 to 240  
The strike activates for the amount of  
time programmed.  
Regardless of how the Door point is  
programmed, the system generates a  
Trouble Door Left Open Event while the  
system is disarmed, and an Alarm Door  
Left Open Event if the system is armed  
and the door is held open beyond Extend  
Time. Door Closed - Restoral Events are  
generated after the door is held open past  
Extend Time and the door returns to  
normal.  
Enter the amount of time the relay output for the  
strike activates to allow a user to open the door. The  
strike activates upon a valid token, RTE, REX, and  
the command center CYCLE DOOR? function.  
D# Shunt Time  
Default:  
10 seconds  
Selection: Blank, 1 second to 240 seconds  
Blank  
Shunt Time is not programmed for this  
door.  
1 to 240  
The shunt activates for the amount of  
time programmed.  
Enter the amount of time that the Door point is  
shunted to allow a user to open the door without  
causing the point to go into trouble, alarm, or a  
faulted condition.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 7.0 RADXAXS  
EN | 134  
Use this program item to disable the strike, but still  
activate the programmed shunt time upon a REX an  
area.  
D# Deact On Open?  
Default:  
Yes  
Use this parameter when a user can open  
a door manually without relying on a  
token/card to activate the strike (such as  
with a push bar).  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Strike deactivates when the door is  
opened after a valid Access Granted  
request.  
Strike remains activated for the amount  
of the programmed strike time whether  
door is opened or closed.  
When REXShunt Only is Yes, REX  
Events are not logged, reported, or  
printed.  
Determines if the strike deactivates immediately  
upon physically opening the door.  
7.3  
Event Profile  
This programming category is used to determine if  
events are created for:  
0101  
01  
In order for this function to work, a point  
needs to be assigned to the door.  
0101  
Access Granted and Access Denied  
Door Requests  
To Reduce False Alarms, maintain D#  
Deact on Open? as the default (Yes). This  
helps prevent the door from bouncing  
open and causing a false alarm.  
Door state changes due to manual (command  
center) or automatic scheduled or armed state  
changes (skeds/hold open on disarm, normal on  
armed) operation.  
D# RTE Shunt Only?  
Door #  
Default:  
No  
Default:  
1
Selection: Yes or No  
Selection: 1 to 8  
Yes  
No  
Programmed shunt time activates so  
door can be manually opened.  
Enter the door you are about to program.  
0101  
01  
0101  
RTE automatically activates the  
programmed strike and shunt time.  
RTE Events require Access Granted to be  
programmed Yes.  
Use this program item to disable the strike, but still  
activate the programmed shunt time upon a Request  
to Exit (REX) area.  
Use this parameter when a user can open  
a door manually without relying on a  
token/card to activate the strike (such as  
with a push bar).  
When RTEShunt Only is Yes, RTE Events  
are not logged, reported, or printed.  
D# REXShunt Only?  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
No  
Programmed shunt time activates so  
the door can be manually opened.  
REX automatically activates the  
programmed strike and shunt time.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | 7.0 RADXAXS  
EN | 135  
D# Enter Request?  
Default: No  
Selection: Yes or No  
D# Access Granted?  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
A Door RTE Event from this door  
controller is sent to the control panel  
for processing.  
Yes  
No  
Access Events from this door controller  
are sent to the control panel for  
processing.  
No  
A Door RTE Event from this door  
controller is not sent to the control  
panel for processing.  
Access Events from this door controller  
are not sent to the control panel for  
processing.  
This program item determines if RTE Events are  
sent to the control panel for processing memory,  
printing, and remote reporting.  
This program item determines if Access Granted  
and Door Request Events are sent to the control  
panel for processing memory, printing, and remote  
reporting.  
0101  
01  
0101  
RTE Events require D# Access Granted  
to be programmed Yes.  
0101  
01  
A successful Access Event can be  
initiated by a(n):  
0101  
Valid user ID  
D# Exit Request?  
Valid door state changed at the  
command center.  
Default:  
No  
Selection: Yes or No  
Automatically scheduled or armed  
state change that holds a door open  
Yes  
No  
A Door RTE Event from this door  
controller is sent to the control panel  
for processing.  
RTE/exit (RTE/REX).  
A Door RTE Event from this door  
controller is not sent to the control  
panel for processing.  
D# No Entry?  
Default:  
No  
This program item determines if REX Events are  
sent to the control panel for processing memory,  
printing, and remote reporting.  
Selection: Yes or No  
Yes  
Access Denied Events from this door  
controller are sent to the control panel  
for processing.  
0101  
01  
0101  
REX Events require D# Access Granted  
to be programmed Yes.  
No  
Access Denied Events from this door  
controller are not sent to the control  
panel for processing.  
This program item determines if No Entry Events  
are sent to the control panel for processing memory,  
printing, and remote reporting.  
0101  
01  
0101  
A No Entry Event can be caused by:  
Invalid or unknown user ID, interlock or  
secured door, or incorrect authority  
level  
RTE/REX for door in interlock or  
secured door.  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 136  
Enhanced Routing........................................23  
Programming a Duplicate Report ..................16  
RG# Primary SDI ...................................24  
RG# Backup SDI ....................................24  
RG# Primary Pager.................................25  
Power Supervision.......................................27  
AC Fail Time ...........................................27  
AC Fail/Res Rpt......................................28  
AC Tag Along..........................................28  
AC/Battery Buzz......................................29  
Bat Fail/Res Rpt ......................................29  
Printer Parameters.......................................29  
Printer Address ........................................29  
P### Area Assign...................................92  
P## Supervised .......................................29  
P## Scope................................................30  
P## A1 [through A8] in Scope.......30  
Programming Prompts  
Directory  
9000MAIN .............................................................11  
Phone...............................................................11  
Phone 1.....................................................11  
Phone 2.....................................................11  
Phone 3.....................................................11  
Phone 4.....................................................11  
Phone Parameters ........................................12  
Modem Format........................................12  
Point/User Flag........................................12  
DTMF Dialing .........................................13  
Phone Supv Time....................................14  
Alarm On Fail..........................................14  
Buzz on Fail..............................................14  
Two Phone Lines.....................................14  
BFSK Duress Code..................................15  
Expand Test Rpt......................................15  
Ground Start ............................................15  
Routing ...........................................................15  
Dialing Attempts............................................16  
Route #.....................................................17  
R# Primary Device .................................17  
R# Backup Device ..................................17  
View Events?............................................17  
Fire Reports.......................................18  
Burglar Reports.................................18  
User Reports.....................................19  
Test Reports......................................14  
Diag Reports.....................................20  
Relay Reports ...................................21  
AutoFunc Reports ............................21  
RAM Reports....................................22  
Point Reports ....................................22  
User Chng Reports...........................23  
Access Reports..................................23  
P## Fire Events.......................................30  
P## Burglar Event ..................................30  
P## Access Event....................................30  
P## User Event.......................................30  
P## Test Event........................................30  
P## Diag Event.......................................30  
P## Auto Functions Event.....................31  
P## RAM Event .....................................31  
P## Relay Event.....................................31  
P## Point Event......................................31  
P## Usr Chng Evt ..................................31  
RAM Parameters ..........................................31  
RAM Callback Reports...................................31  
RAM Passcode.........................................32  
Log % Full ................................................32  
RAM Call Back........................................32  
RAM Line Monitor.................................32  
Answer Armed.........................................33  
Answer Disarmed....................................33  
Ram Ph.....................................................33  
Miscellaneous..............................................127  
Duress Type .............................................34  
Cancel Report..........................................34  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 137  
CC# Assign Door....................................49  
CC# Trouble Tone .................................49  
CC# Entry Tone......................................49  
CC# Exit Tone........................................49  
CC# Arm Now Warn.............................50  
CC# Close Door .....................................50  
CC# EnhancCmdCtr..............................50  
Area Text .......................................................50  
Area...........................................................50  
Area# Is On.............................................50  
Area # Not Ready...................................50  
Area # Is Off............................................50  
Area # Acct Is On...................................51  
Custom Function ............................................51  
Custom Function .....................................51  
CF### Text.............................................51  
CF### Key Strokes................................52  
User Interface................................................53  
Command Center Selections............................53  
Master Arm Delay...................................54  
Mstr Arm Inst ..........................................54  
Perim Instant............................................54  
Perim Delay..............................................54  
Watch Mode.............................................54  
Perim Partial.............................................54  
View Area Stat.........................................55  
View Memory..........................................55  
View Pt Status..........................................55  
Walk Test..................................................55  
Fire Test....................................................55  
Send Report .............................................55  
Door Control............................................55  
Access Ctl Level ......................................56  
Chg Display..............................................56  
Chg Time/Date........................................56  
Chg Passcode ...........................................56  
Add User ..................................................56  
Del User....................................................56  
Extend Close............................................56  
View Log ..................................................56  
Print Log...................................................57  
Area Parameters...........................................34  
Area Parameters.............................................34  
Area...........................................................34  
A# Area On.............................................34  
Error! Reference source not found.Error!  
Bookmark not defined.  
A# FA Bypass Max.................................36  
A# Delay Res...........................................36  
A# Exit Tone...........................................36  
A# Exit Dly Time ...................................36  
A# Auto Watch .......................................37  
A# Verify Time.......................................37  
A# Duress Enable ...................................38  
A# Area Type..........................................39  
Bell Parameters ..............................................40  
Area...........................................................40  
A# Fire Time ...........................................41  
A# Fire Pat...............................................41  
A# Burg Time..........................................41  
A# Burg Pat .............................................41  
A# Single Ring ........................................41  
A# Bell Test.............................................42  
Open/Close Options........................................42  
Area...........................................................43  
A# Acct O/C...........................................43  
A# Area O/C...........................................44  
A# Disable O/C in Window..................44  
A# Auto Close.........................................44  
A# Fail to Open ......................................44  
A# Fail to Close.......................................45  
A# Restrictd O/C....................................45  
A# Perimeter O/C ..................................46  
Command Center.........................................46  
Cmd Cntr (Command Center) Assignment .....46  
Cmd Center .............................................46  
CC# Supervised ......................................47  
CC# Area Assign ....................................47  
CC# Scope...............................................47  
CC# A1[through A8] in Scope.......48  
CC# Entr Key Rly ..................................48  
CC# Entr Cycl Dr...................................48  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 138  
User Cmd 7..............................................57  
User Cmd 9..............................................57  
Bypass a Pt ...............................................57  
Unbypass a Pt ..........................................57  
Reset Sensors ...........................................57  
Change Relay...........................................57  
Remote Program......................................57  
Move to Area...........................................58  
Display Rev..............................................58  
Service Walk ............................................58  
Default Text .............................................58  
Change Skeds...........................................58  
C Function 128 [through 143]................58  
Authority Level Selections...............................59  
Authority Level........................................59  
L## Disarm .............................................59  
L## Master Arm Delay..........................59  
L## Mstr Arm Inst .................................59  
L## Perim Instant...................................60  
L## Perim Delay ....................................60  
L## Watch Mode ...................................60  
L## Perim Partial....................................60  
L## View Area Stat................................60  
L## View Memory.................................60  
L## View Pt Status.................................60  
L## Walk Test ........................................60  
L## Fire Test...........................................61  
L## Send Report ....................................61  
L## Door Control...................................61  
L## Cycle Door...............................61  
L## User Cmd 7.....................................63  
L## User Cmd 9.....................................64  
L## Bypass a Pt.......................................64  
L## Unbypass a Pt .................................64  
L## Reset Sensors...................................64  
L## Change Relay..................................64  
L## Remote Program.............................64  
L## Move to Area..................................64  
L## Display Rev.....................................64  
L## Service Walk ...................................64  
L## Default Text ....................................65  
L## Change Skeds..................................65  
L## C Function 128 [through 143].......65  
L## Force Arm .......................................65  
L## Area O/C.........................................65  
L## Restricted O/C................................65  
L## Perimeter O/C................................65  
L## Send Duress.....................................65  
L## Passcode Arm..................................65  
L## Passcode Disarm.............................66  
L## Security Level..................................66  
L## Disarm Level...................................66  
Function List ..................................................67  
Menu Item................................................67  
M## Function..........................................67  
M## CC Address 1 [through 8]............67  
Relay Parameters .........................................67  
Area Relays ....................................................68  
Area...........................................................68  
A# Alarm Bell..........................................68  
A# Fire Bell..............................................69  
A# Reset Sensors.....................................69  
A# Fail to Close.......................................69  
A# Force Armed .....................................69  
A# Watch Mode......................................69  
A# Area Armed.......................................70  
A# Area Fault ..........................................70  
A# Duress Relay .....................................70  
A# Perim Fault ........................................70  
A# Silent Alarm.......................................70  
L## Unlock Door............................62  
L## Secure Door..........................62  
L## Access Ctl Lvl.................................62  
L## Chg Display.....................................63  
L## Chg Time/Date...............................63  
L## Chg Passcode..................................63  
L## Add User .........................................63  
L## Del User...........................................63  
L## Extend Close...................................63  
L## View Log.........................................63  
L## Print Log..........................................63  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 139  
P## Local While Armed........................86  
P## Disable Rst.......................................87  
P## FA Retrnable...................................87  
P## BP Retrnable ...................................87  
P## Bypassable .......................................88  
P## Swinger Byps...................................88  
P## Report Bypass at Occurrence........88  
P## Defer BP Report .............................89  
P## Cross Point ......................................89  
P## Fire Point .........................................90  
P## Alarm Verify ...................................91  
P## Resettable.........................................91  
Point Assignments........................................91  
Point Number...........................................91  
P### Point Index ...................................92  
P### Area Assign...................................92  
P### Debounce......................................92  
P### BFSK/Relay..................................93  
P### Point Text......................................93  
COMMAND 7 and COMMAND 9...........94  
CMD7 Point Index..................................94  
CMD7 BFSK/Relay ................................94  
CMD7 Point Text....................................94  
CMD9 Point Index..................................94  
CMD9 BFSK/Relay ................................94  
CMD9 Point Text....................................94  
RADXSKED..........................................................95  
Windows.........................................................95  
Opening and Closing ......................................95  
Window ....................................................95  
W# Sunday ..............................................95  
W# Monday.............................................96  
W# Tuesday.............................................96  
W# Wednesday.......................................96  
W# Thursday...........................................96  
W# Friday................................................96  
W# Saturday............................................96  
W# Open Early Begin............................96  
W# Open Window Start ........................96  
W# Open Window Stop.........................97  
W# Close Early Begin............................98  
Panel-Wide Relays .........................................71  
AC Failure................................................71  
Battery Trouble........................................71  
Phone Fail.................................................71  
Comm Fail................................................72  
Log % Full ................................................72  
Summary Fire ..........................................72  
Summary Alarm ......................................72  
Summary Fire Tbl ...................................72  
Summary SupFire....................................72  
Summary Trouble ...................................72  
Summary SupBurg ..................................72  
RADXUSR1/RADXUSR2..................................73  
Passcode/Token Worksheet.......................73  
Reporting and Logging....................................73  
User ###..................................................74  
U### Passcode .......................................74  
U### User Group..................................75  
U### Area 1 [through Area 8] Auth....75  
U### Name ............................................75  
U### Mstr Site .......................................75  
U### Mstr C/D......................................76  
U### SU1 through SU3 Site ................76  
U### SU1 through SU3 C/D...............76  
RADXPNTS ..........................................................77  
Point Index.....................................................77  
Point Index...............................................77  
P## Type .................................................77  
Point Responses ..............................................81  
P## Pt Response.....................................82  
P## Entry Delay .....................................83  
P## Ent Tone Off...................................83  
P## Silent Bell.........................................83  
P## Ring Til Rst.....................................83  
P## Audible After 2 Failures.................84  
P## Invisible Pt.......................................84  
P## Buzz On Fault .................................85  
P## Watch Point.....................................85  
P## RlyResp Type .................................86  
P## Disp as Dvc .....................................86  
P## Local While Disarmed...................86  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 140  
W# Close Window Start ........................99  
W# Close Window Stop.........................99  
W# Xept Holiday..................................100  
W# Holiday 1........................................100  
W# Holiday 2........................................100  
W# Holiday 3........................................100  
W# Holiday 4........................................100  
W# Area 1 [through 8] .........................100  
User Group Windows...................................102  
User Windows #....................................102  
S## Cmd Center 1[through 8] .....109  
S## Access Ctl Level #.................109  
S## Access Ctl Level#..................109  
S## Door 1 [through 8].................109  
S## Door 1 [through 8].................110  
S## Door 1 [through 8].................110  
S## Door 1 [through 8].................110  
S## Door 1 [through 8].................111  
S## Door 1 [through 8].................110  
S## Door 1 [through 8].................111  
UW# User Group .................................102  
UW# Sunday.........................................103  
UW# Monday .......................................103  
UW# Tuesday .......................................103  
UW# Wednesday..................................103  
UW# Thursday......................................103  
UW# Friday...........................................103  
UW# Saturday.......................................103  
UW# Group Enable..............................103  
UW# Group Disable.............................103  
UW# Xept Holiday ..............................104  
UW# Holiday 1.....................................104  
UW# Holiday 2.....................................104  
UW# Holiday 3.....................................104  
UW# Holiday 4.....................................104  
Skeds .............................................................104  
Sked Number.........................................104  
S## TimeEdit ........................................104  
S## Function Code...............................105  
S## Area 1[through 8] ..................105  
S## Area 1[through 8] ..................105  
S## Point Number.........................105  
S## Point Number.........................105  
S## Area 1[through 8] ..................106  
S## Relay Number........................106  
S## Relay Number........................106  
S## Defer Test...............................107  
S## Hourly Report........................107  
S## Defer Status ............................107  
S## Cmd Center............................108  
S## Custom Func..........................108  
S## Time ...............................................112  
S## Date ................................................112  
S## Sunday............................................112  
S## Monday..........................................112  
S## Tuesday..........................................112  
S## Wednesday ....................................112  
S## Thursday........................................112  
S## Friday .............................................112  
S## Saturday .........................................112  
S## Xept Holiday.................................113  
S## Holiday 1 .......................................113  
S## Holiday 2 .......................................113  
S## Holiday 3 .......................................113  
S## Holiday 4 .......................................113  
Holiday Indexes..........................................113  
Add/Change/Delete.......................................113  
Date.........................................................113  
Holiday Index 1.....................................114  
Holiday Index 2.....................................114  
Holiday Index 3.....................................114  
Holiday Index 4.....................................114  
View Holidays..............................................114  
Index 1 Days..........................................114  
Index 2 Days..........................................114  
Index 3 Days..........................................114  
Index 4 Days..........................................114  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D9412G/D7412G | Program Entry Guide | Programming Prompts Directory  
EN | 141  
9133 Supervision ...................................126  
Base Port Number .................................126  
Route Group Attempts..................................126  
RG# 1 Attempt......................................127  
Miscellaneous..............................................127  
Fire Supv Res Type...............................127  
Enable Protocol Type ...........................127  
Enable Anti Replay...............................127  
Fire Trouble Resound...........................127  
Cross Point Parameters.............................128  
Cross Point Time...................................129  
RADXAXS...........................................................131  
Door Profile .................................................131  
Door # ....................................................131  
D# Entry Area #...................................131  
D#CC#Scope ........................................131  
D# Door Point.......................................131  
D# Interlock Point ................................132  
D# Auto Door?......................................132  
D# Fire Unlock?....................................132  
D# Disarm on Open?...........................132  
D# Card Type .......................................133  
Strike Profile................................................133  
Door # ....................................................133  
D# Strike Time......................................133  
D# Shunt Time......................................133  
D# Buzz Time........................................133  
D# Extend Time....................................133  
D# Deact On Open?.............................134  
D# RTE Shunt Only?...........................134  
D# REXShunt Only?............................134  
Event Profile................................................134  
Door # ....................................................134  
D# Access Granted? .............................135  
D# No Entry? ........................................135  
D# Enter Request?................................135  
D# Exit Request? ..................................135  
RADXAUX1........................................................115  
SDI Automation..........................................115  
Enable SDI Auto ...................................115  
Baud Rate...............................................115  
Parity/Stop..............................................115  
9133 Supervision ...................................116  
RTS Control...........................................116  
DTR Control..........................................116  
Status Rate..............................................116  
SDI RAM Parameters................................116  
User Interface Modifications for COMMAND 43  
.....................................................................117  
Enable SDI RAM..................................117  
Call Back Enabled.................................118  
RAM IP Address 1................................118  
RAM IP Address 2................................118  
RAM IP Address 3................................118  
RAM IP Address 4................................118  
Using an External Modem............................118  
Enable Ext Modem ...............................122  
Answer Armed.......................................122  
Answer Disarmed..................................122  
RAM Line Monitor...............................122  
Seize Relay.............................................122  
Modem Init String.................................122  
RAM Dial String....................................122  
Enhanced Communications.....................122  
Enhanced Comm...................................123  
Programming Path Numbers and IP Addresses123  
Path # IP Add1......................................123  
Path # IP Add2......................................123  
Path # IP Add3......................................123  
Path # IP Add4......................................123  
Path # Poll Rate.....................................123  
Path # Ack Wait....................................125  
Path # Retry Count...............................125  
SDI RAM/Enhanced Communications  
Configuration..............................................125  
Baud Rate...............................................125  
Parity/Stop..............................................126  
RTS Control...........................................126  
DTR Control..........................................126  
Bosch Security Systems | 1/04 | 47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bosch Security Systems  
130 Perinton Parkway  
Fairport, NY 14450-9199  
Customer Service: (800) 289-0096  
Technical Support: (888) 886-6189  
© 2003 Bosch Security Systems  
47775E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Belkin Surge Protector F9G1033 12 User Manual
Best Ventilation Hood WPD28I User Manual
Bodum Gas Grill 11450P User Manual
Briggs Stratton Lawn Mower 1695287 User Manual
Brookstone Humidifier BWM 2110 User Manual
Brother Fax Machine MFC6490CW User Manual
Casablanca Fan Company Outdoor Ceiling Fan 69xxD User Manual
Casio Conference Phone TQ 378 User Manual
Casio Electronic Keyboard CS 44P User Manual
Chicago Electric Saw Cookerhoods User Manual